blob: 89d6dd7097b6c82d8e0567acb354c92dfba4e60c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau04df1122011-04-08 00:56:41 +02007 2011/04/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100451 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - noepoll
453 - nokqueue
454 - nopoll
455 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200457 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200458 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200459 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100460 - tune.maxaccept
461 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100463 - tune.rcvbuf.client
464 - tune.rcvbuf.server
465 - tune.sndbuf.client
466 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 * Debugging
469 - debug
470 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471
472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474------------------------------------
475
476chroot <jail dir>
477 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
478 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
479 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
480 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
481 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
482 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484daemon
485 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
486 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
487 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
488
489gid <number>
490 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
491 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
492 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
493 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495group <group name>
496 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
497 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200499log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
501 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100502 configured with "log global".
503
504 <address> can be one of:
505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
508 port).
509
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100510 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100514 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
515 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
516 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
517 writeable).
518
519 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520
521 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
522 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
523 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
524
525 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200526 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
527 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
528 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
529 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
530 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
531 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532
533 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
534
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100535log-send-hostname [<string>]
536 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
537 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
538 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
539 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
540 the logs.
541
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000542log-tag <string>
543 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
544 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
545 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
546 running on the same host.
547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548nbproc <number>
549 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
550 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
551 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
552 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
553 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
554
555pidfile <pidfile>
556 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
557 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
558 starting the process. See also "daemon".
559
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200560stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200561 [level <level>]
562
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200563 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
564 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100565 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200566 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
567
568 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
569 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
570 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
571 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
572 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
573
574 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
575 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
576 counters).
577
578 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
579 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100580
581 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
582 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
583 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
584 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
585 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
586 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
587 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200588
589stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
590 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
591 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100592 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats maxconn <connections>
595 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
596 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
597
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598uid <number>
599 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
600 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
601 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
602 one. See also "gid" and "user".
603
604ulimit-n <number>
605 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
606 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
607 option.
608
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100609unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
610 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
611
612 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
613 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
614 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
615 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
616 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
617 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
618 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
619 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
620 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
621 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623user <user name>
624 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
625 See also "uid" and "group".
626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200627node <name>
628 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
629
630 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
631 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
632 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
633 traffic.
634
635description <text>
636 Add a text that describes the instance.
637
638 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
639 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
640 "<" and ">" characters.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644-----------------------
645
646maxconn <number>
647 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
648 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
649 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
650 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
651
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652maxpipes <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
654 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
655 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
656 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
657 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
658 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
659
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660noepoll
661 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
662 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
663 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
664
665nokqueue
666 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
667 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
668 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
669
670nopoll
671 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
672 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100673 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
675 "nokqueue".
676
677nosepoll
678 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
679 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
680 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
681
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100682nosplice
683 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
684 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
685 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100686 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100687 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
688 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
689 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
690 "option splice-response".
691
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200692spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
693 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
694 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
695 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
696 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
697 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
698
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200699tune.bufsize <number>
700 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
701 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
702 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
703 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
704 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
705 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
706 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
707 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
708
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200709tune.chksize <number>
710 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
711 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
712 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
713 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
714 checks whenever possible.
715
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100716tune.maxaccept <number>
717 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
718 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
719 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100720 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100721 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
722 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100723 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100724 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
725
726tune.maxpollevents <number>
727 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
728 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
729 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
730 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
731 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
732
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200733tune.maxrewrite <number>
734 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
735 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
736 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
737 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
738 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
739 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
740 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
741 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
742 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
743 bufsize.
744
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100745tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
746tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
747 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
748 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
749 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
750 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
751 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
752 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
753 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
754
755tune.sndbuf.client <number>
756tune.sndbuf.server <number>
757 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
758 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
759 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
760 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
761 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
762 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
763 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
764 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
765 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
766 notifying haproxy again.
767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693.3. Debugging
770--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771
772debug
773 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
774 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
775 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
776 system startup.
777
778quiet
779 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
780 line argument "-q".
781
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007833.4. Userlists
784--------------
785It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
786http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
787it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
788
789userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100790 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100791 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
792
793group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100794 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100795 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
796 proceeded by "users" keyword.
797
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100798user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
799 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100800 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
801 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100802 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
803 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100804 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
805 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
806
807
808 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100809 userlist L1
810 group G1 users tiger,scott
811 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100812
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100813 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
814 user scott insecure-password elgato
815 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100816
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100817 userlist L2
818 group G1
819 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100820
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100821 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
822 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
823 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824
825 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200826
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200827
8283.5. Peers
829--------------
830It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
831haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
832pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
833identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
834or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
835Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
836known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
837the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
838process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
839during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
840tables.
841
842peers <peersect>
843 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
844 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
845
846peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
847 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
848 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
849 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
850 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
851 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
852 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
853
854 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
855 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
856
857 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
858 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
859 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
860 across all peers.
861
862Example:
863 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100864 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
865 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
866 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200867
868 backend mybackend
869 mode tcp
870 balance roundrobin
871 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
872 stick on src
873
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100874 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
875 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
882 - defaults <name>
883 - frontend <name>
884 - backend <name>
885 - listen <name>
886
887A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
888its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
889section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100890section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
892A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
893connections.
894
895A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
896to forward incoming connections.
897
898A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
899parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100901All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
902'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
903case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
904
905Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
906logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
907proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
908However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
909name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
910
911Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
912and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
915modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
916arbitrary criteria.
917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194.1. Proxy keywords matrix
920--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
923limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
924they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
925limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100926marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200927option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200928and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
929with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
930specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100933 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
934------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
935acl - X X X
936appsession - - X X
937backlog X X X -
938balance X - X X
939bind - X X -
940bind-process X X X X
941block - X X X
942capture cookie - X X -
943capture request header - X X -
944capture response header - X X -
945clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
946contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
947cookie X - X X
948default-server X - X X
949default_backend X X X -
950description - X X X
951disabled X X X X
952dispatch - - X X
953enabled X X X X
954errorfile X X X X
955errorloc X X X X
956errorloc302 X X X X
957-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
958errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200959force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960fullconn X - X X
961grace X X X X
962hash-type X - X X
963http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100964http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200965http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966http-request - X X X
967id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200968ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100969log X X X X
970maxconn X X X -
971mode X X X X
972monitor fail - X X -
973monitor-net X X X -
974monitor-uri X X X -
975option abortonclose (*) X - X X
976option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
977option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
978option allbackups (*) X - X X
979option checkcache (*) X - X X
980option clitcpka (*) X X X -
981option contstats (*) X X X -
982option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
983option dontlognull (*) X X X -
984option forceclose (*) X X X X
985-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
986option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200987option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200988option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100989option http-server-close (*) X X X X
990option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
991option httpchk X - X X
992option httpclose (*) X X X X
993option httplog X X X X
994option http_proxy (*) X X X X
995option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200996option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100997option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
998option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
999option logasap (*) X X X -
1000option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001001option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001002option nolinger (*) X X X X
1003option originalto X X X X
1004option persist (*) X - X X
1005option redispatch (*) X - X X
1006option smtpchk X - X X
1007option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1008option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1009option splice-request (*) X X X X
1010option splice-response (*) X X X X
1011option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1012option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1013-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1014option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1015option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1016option tcpka X X X X
1017option tcplog X X X X
1018option transparent (*) X - X X
1019persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1020rate-limit sessions X X X -
1021redirect - X X X
1022redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1023redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1024reqadd - X X X
1025reqallow - X X X
1026reqdel - X X X
1027reqdeny - X X X
1028reqiallow - X X X
1029reqidel - X X X
1030reqideny - X X X
1031reqipass - X X X
1032reqirep - X X X
1033reqisetbe - X X X
1034reqitarpit - X X X
1035reqpass - X X X
1036reqrep - X X X
1037-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1038reqsetbe - X X X
1039reqtarpit - X X X
1040retries X - X X
1041rspadd - X X X
1042rspdel - X X X
1043rspdeny - X X X
1044rspidel - X X X
1045rspideny - X X X
1046rspirep - X X X
1047rsprep - X X X
1048server - - X X
1049source X - X X
1050srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001051stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001052stats auth X - X X
1053stats enable X - X X
1054stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001055stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001056stats realm X - X X
1057stats refresh X - X X
1058stats scope X - X X
1059stats show-desc X - X X
1060stats show-legends X - X X
1061stats show-node X - X X
1062stats uri X - X X
1063-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1064stick match - - X X
1065stick on - - X X
1066stick store-request - - X X
1067stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001068tcp-request connection - X X -
1069tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001070tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001071tcp-response content - - X X
1072tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001073timeout check X - X X
1074timeout client X X X -
1075timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1076timeout connect X - X X
1077timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1078timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1079timeout http-request X X X X
1080timeout queue X - X X
1081timeout server X - X X
1082timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1083timeout tarpit X X X X
1084transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1085use_backend - X X -
1086------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1087 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1091---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092
1093This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1094
1095
1096acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1097 Declare or complete an access list.
1098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1099 no | yes | yes | yes
1100 Example:
1101 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1102 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1103 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001105 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001106
1107
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001108appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1109 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001110 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1112 no | no | yes | yes
1113 Arguments :
1114 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1115 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1116
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001117 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001118 checked in each cookie value.
1119
1120 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1121 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1122 milliseconds.
1123
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001124 request-learn
1125 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1126 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1127 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1128 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1129 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1130 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1131
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001132 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1133 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1134 data following this prefix.
1135
1136 Example :
1137 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1138
1139 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1140 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1141
1142 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1143 2 modes are currently supported :
1144 - path-parameters :
1145 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1146 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1147 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1148 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1149 - query-string :
1150 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1151 query string.
1152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001153 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1154 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1155 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1156 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1158 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1159 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001160 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1161 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1162
1163 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1164
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001165 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1166 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1167 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169 Example :
1170 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1171
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001172 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1173 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001174
1175
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001176backlog <conns>
1177 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1179 yes | yes | yes | no
1180 Arguments :
1181 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1182 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1183 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1184
1185 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1186 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1187 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1188 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1189 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1190 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1191 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1192 backlog parameter.
1193
1194 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1195 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1196 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1197
1198 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1199
1200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001201balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001202balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1205 yes | no | yes | yes
1206 Arguments :
1207 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1208 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1209 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1210 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1211
1212 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1213 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1214 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1215 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001216 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1217 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1218 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1219 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1220 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1221 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1222 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1223 it, so that you don't worry.
1224
1225 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1226 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1227 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1228 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1229 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1230 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1231 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1232 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001234 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1235 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1236 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1237 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1238 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1239 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1240 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1241 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1244 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1245 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1246 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1247 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1248 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1249 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1250 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001251 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001252 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001253 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1254 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1255 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001256
1257 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1258 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1259 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1260 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1261 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1262 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1263 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001264 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1265 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1266 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001267
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001268 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1269 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1270 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1271 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1272 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1273 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1274 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1275 URIs start with a leading "/".
1276
1277 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1278 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1279 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1280 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001283 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1284
1285 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1286 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001287 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1288 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001289 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1290 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1291 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1292 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1293 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1294 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1295 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1296 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1297 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1298 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1299 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1300 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1301 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1302 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1303 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1304 be randomly balanced if at all.
1305
1306 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1307 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1308 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1309 server will receive the request.
1310
1311 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1312 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1313 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1314 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1315 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001316 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1317 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1318 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001320 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1321 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1322 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001323 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001324 algorithm is applied instead.
1325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001326 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001327 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1328 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1329 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1330
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001331 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1332 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1333 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1334
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001335 rdp-cookie
1336 rdp-cookie(name)
1337 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1338 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1339 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1340 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1341 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1342 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001343 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001344 used instead.
1345
1346 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1347 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1348 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1349 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1350
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001351 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1352 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1353 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1354
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001355 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001357 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001358 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1359 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001360
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001361 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001362 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001363
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001364 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1365 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1366 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001367
1368 Examples :
1369 balance roundrobin
1370 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001371 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001372 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1373 balance hdr(host)
1374 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001375
1376 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1377 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001379 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001380 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1381 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1382 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1383 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1384
1385 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1386 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1387 defaults to 16 kB.
1388
1389 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1390 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1391
1392 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1393 Round Robin.
1394
1395 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1396 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1397 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1398 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1399
1400 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1401
1402 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001403 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001404 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1405 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1406 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001407
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001408 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1409 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410
1411
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001412bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1413bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1414bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1415bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1416bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1417bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1418bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001419bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001420bind /<path> [, ...]
1421bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1422bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1423bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1426 no | yes | yes | no
1427 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001428 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1429 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1430 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1431 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001432 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001433
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001434 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1435 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001436 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1437 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1438 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001439 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1440 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1441 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1442 the range.
1443
1444 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1445 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1446 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1447 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1448 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1449 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1450 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1451 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1452 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001453
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001454 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1455 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1456 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1457 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1458 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1459 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1460 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1461 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1462
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001463 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1464 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1465 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1466 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1467 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1468 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1469 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1470 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001471 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1472 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001473
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001474 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1475 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1476 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1477 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1478 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1479 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001480 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1481 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1482 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1483 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1484 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1485 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1486 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1487 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001488
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001489 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1490 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1491 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1492 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001493
1494 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1495
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001496 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1497 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1498 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1499 simply ignore this.
1500
1501 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1502 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1503 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1504 simply ignore this.
1505
1506 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1507 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1508 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1509 this.
1510
1511 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1512 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1513 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1514 this.
1515
1516 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1517 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1518 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1519 this.
1520
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001521 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1522 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1523 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001524 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001525 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1526 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1527 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1528 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001529 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1530 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001531
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001532 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001533 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1534 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1535 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1536 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1537 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1538 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1539 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1540 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1541 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1542 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1543 with front firewalls which would see an established
1544 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1545
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001546 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1547 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1548 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1549 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1550 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1551 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1552 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1553 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1554 This keyword combined with support from external components
1555 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1556 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1557 not even always usable.
1558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001559 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1560 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1561 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1562 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1563 in a frontend.
1564
1565 Example :
1566 listen http_proxy
1567 bind :80,:443
1568 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001569 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001571 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001572 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
1574
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001575bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1576 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1578 yes | yes | yes | yes
1579 Arguments :
1580 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1581 may be used to override a default value.
1582
1583 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1584 option may be combined with other numbers.
1585
1586 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1587 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1588 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1589 missing from all processes.
1590
1591 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1592 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1593 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1594 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1595
1596 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1597 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1598 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1599 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1600 and 'even' instances.
1601
1602 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1603 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1604 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1605 32.
1606
1607 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1608 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1609
1610 Example :
1611 listen app_ip1
1612 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001613 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001614
1615 listen app_ip2
1616 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001617 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001618
1619 listen management
1620 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001621 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001622
1623 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1624
1625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626block { if | unless } <condition>
1627 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1629 no | yes | yes | yes
1630
1631 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1632 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001633 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1635 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1636 "block" statements per instance.
1637
1638 Example:
1639 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1640 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1641 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1642 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001644 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645
1646
1647capture cookie <name> len <length>
1648 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1650 no | yes | yes | no
1651 Arguments :
1652 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1653 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1654 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1655 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1656 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1657
1658 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1659 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1660 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1661 right if it exceeds <length>.
1662
1663 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1664 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1665 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1666 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1667
1668 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1669 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1670 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1671
1672 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1673 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1674 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1675 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001676 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1678
1679 Example:
1680 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1681
1682 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001683 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684
1685
1686capture request header <name> len <length>
1687 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1689 no | yes | yes | no
1690 Arguments :
1691 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001692 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001693 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1694 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1695 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1696
1697 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1698 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1699 it exceeds <length>.
1700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001701 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001702 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1703 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001704 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1705 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1706 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1707 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001709 environments to find where the request came from.
1710
1711 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1712 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1713 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1714 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715
1716 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1717 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1718 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1719 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1720
1721 Example:
1722 capture request header Host len 15
1723 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1724 capture request header Referrer len 15
1725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001726 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001727 about logging.
1728
1729
1730capture response header <name> len <length>
1731 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1733 no | yes | yes | no
1734 Arguments :
1735 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001736 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1738 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1739 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1740
1741 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1742 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1743 it exceeds <length>.
1744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001745 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1747 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1748 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001749 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1750 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1751 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1752 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001753
1754 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1755 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1756 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1757 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1758
1759 Example:
1760 capture response header Content-length len 9
1761 capture response header Location len 15
1762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001763 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001764 about logging.
1765
1766
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001767clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1770 yes | yes | yes | no
1771 Arguments :
1772 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1773 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1774 as explained at the top of this document.
1775
1776 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1777 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1778 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1779 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1780 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1781 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1782 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1783 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001784 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1786 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1787
1788 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1789 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1790 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1791 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1792 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1793 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1794
1795 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1796 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1797
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001798 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1799 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800
1801
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001802contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1805 yes | no | yes | yes
1806 Arguments :
1807 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1808 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1809 as explained at the top of this document.
1810
1811 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001812 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001813 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1815 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1816 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1817 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1818
1819 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1820 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1821 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1822 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1823 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1824 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1825
1826 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1827 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1828 instead.
1829
1830 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1831 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1832
1833
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001834cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001835 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001836 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1839 yes | no | yes | yes
1840 Arguments :
1841 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1842 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1843 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1844 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1845 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1846 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1847 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1848 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1849 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1850
1851 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1852 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1853 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1854 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1855 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1856 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1857 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1858 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1859 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1860 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1861 "insert" and "prefix".
1862
1863 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001864 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001865
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001866 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001867 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1868 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1869 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1870 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1871 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1872 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1873 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1874 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1875 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1876 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001877
1878 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1879 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1880 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1881 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1882 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1883 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1884 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1885 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1886 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1887 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1888 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1889
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001890 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1891 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1892 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001893 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1894 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1895 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1896 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001897
1898 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1899 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1900 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1901 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1902 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1903 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1904 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1905 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1906 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1907
1908 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1909 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1910 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1911 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1912 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1913 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1914 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1915 persistence cookie in the cache.
1916 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1917
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001918 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1919 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1920 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1921 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1922 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1923 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1924 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1925 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1926 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1927 they logout.
1928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001929 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001930 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001931 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1932 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1933 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1934 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1935 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1936 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001937
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001938 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1939 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1940 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1941 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1942 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1943 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1944 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1945 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1946 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1947 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1948 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1949 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1950 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1951 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1952 the site.
1953
1954 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1955 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1956 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1957 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1958 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1959 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1960 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1961 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1962 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1963 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1964 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1965 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1966 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1967 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1968 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1969 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001971 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1972 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1973 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1974 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001976 Examples :
1977 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1978 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1979 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001980 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001982 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001983 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001986default-server [param*]
1987 Change default options for a server in a backend
1988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1989 yes | no | yes | yes
1990 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001991 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1992 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1993 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1994 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001995
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001996 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001997 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1998
1999 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002default_backend <backend>
2003 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2005 yes | yes | yes | no
2006 Arguments :
2007 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2008
2009 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2010 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2011 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2012 will catch all undetermined requests.
2013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014 Example :
2015
2016 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2017 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2018 default_backend dynamic
2019
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002020 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002022
2023disabled
2024 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2026 yes | yes | yes | yes
2027 Arguments : none
2028
2029 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2030 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2031 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2032 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2033 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2034 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2035 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2036
2037 See also : "enabled"
2038
2039
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002040dispatch <address>:<port>
2041 Set a default server address
2042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2043 no | no | yes | yes
2044 Arguments : none
2045
2046 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2047 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2048 during start-up.
2049
2050 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2051 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2052 possible with normal servers.
2053
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002054 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002055 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2056 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2057 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2058 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2059
2060 See also : "server"
2061
2062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063enabled
2064 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2066 yes | yes | yes | yes
2067 Arguments : none
2068
2069 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2070 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2071
2072 See also : "disabled"
2073
2074
2075errorfile <code> <file>
2076 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2078 yes | yes | yes | yes
2079 Arguments :
2080 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002081 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082
2083 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002084 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002086 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2087 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002088
2089 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2090 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2091 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2092
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002093 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2096 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2097 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2098 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2099
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002100 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2101 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2102 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2103 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2104 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2105 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002107 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2108 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2109 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002110 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2112
2113 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2114
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002115 Example :
2116 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2117 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2118 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2119
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002120
2121errorloc <code> <url>
2122errorloc302 <code> <url>
2123 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2125 yes | yes | yes | yes
2126 Arguments :
2127 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002128 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002129
2130 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2131 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2132 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2133 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2134 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2135
2136 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2137 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2138 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2139
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002140 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2141
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002142 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2143 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2144 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2145 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2146 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2147 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2148 request.
2149
2150 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2151
2152
2153errorloc303 <code> <url>
2154 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2156 yes | yes | yes | yes
2157 Arguments :
2158 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2159 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2160
2161 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2162 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2163 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2164 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2165 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2166
2167 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2168 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2169 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2170
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002171 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2172
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002173 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2174 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2175 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2176 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002177 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002178
2179 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2180
2181
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002182force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2183 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2184 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2185 no | yes | yes | yes
2186
2187 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2188 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2189 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2190 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2191 marked down for maintenance operations.
2192
2193 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2194 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2195 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2196 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2197 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2198 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2199 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2200 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2201 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2202
2203 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2204 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2205 is used.
2206
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002207 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002208 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002209
2210
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002211fullconn <conns>
2212 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2214 yes | no | yes | yes
2215 Arguments :
2216 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2217 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2218
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002219 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002220 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002221 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002222 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2223 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2224 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2225 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2226 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002227 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002228
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002229 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2230 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2231 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2232
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002233 Example :
2234 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2235 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2236 # connections.
2237 backend dynamic
2238 fullconn 10000
2239 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2240 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2241
2242 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2243
2244
2245grace <time>
2246 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002248 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002249 Arguments :
2250 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2251 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2252 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2253
2254 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2255 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002256 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002257 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2258
2259 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2260 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2261 simplify it.
2262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002264hash-type <method>
2265 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2267 yes | no | yes | yes
2268 Arguments :
2269 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2270 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2271 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2272 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2273 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2274 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2275 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2276 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2277 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2278
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002279 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2280 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2281 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2282 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2283 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2284 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2285 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2286 this value.
2287
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002288 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2289 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2290 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2291 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2292 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2293 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2294 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2295 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2296 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2297 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2298 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2299 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2300 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2301
2302 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2303
2304 See also : "balance", "server"
2305
2306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307http-check disable-on-404
2308 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002310 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311 Arguments : none
2312
2313 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2314 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2315 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2316 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2317 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2318 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2319 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2320 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002321 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2322 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2323 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2324
2325 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2326
2327
2328http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2329 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2331 no | no | yes | yes
2332 Arguments :
2333 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2334 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2335 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2336 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2337 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2338 details on the supported keywords.
2339
2340 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2341 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2342 with the usual backslash ('\').
2343
2344 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2345 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2346 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2347 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2348 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2349
2350 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2351 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2352 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2353 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2354 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2355
2356 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2357 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2358 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2359 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2360 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2361 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2362
2363 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2364 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2365 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2366 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2367 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2368 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2369 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2370 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2371 trace).
2372
2373 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2374 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2375 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2376 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2377 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2378 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2379 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2380 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2381
2382 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2383 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2384 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2385 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2386 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2387 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2388 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2389 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2390
2391 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2392 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2393
2394 Examples :
2395 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002396 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002397
2398 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002399 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002400
2401 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002402 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002403
2404 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002405 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002406
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002407 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002408
2409
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002410http-check send-state
2411 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2413 yes | no | yes | yes
2414 Arguments : none
2415
2416 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2417 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2418 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2419 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2420 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2421
2422 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2423 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2424 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2425 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2426 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2427 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2428 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2429 checked in multiple backends.
2430
2431 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2432 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2433
2434 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2435 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2436 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2437 one fails.
2438
2439 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2440 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2441 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2442
2443 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2444 server's queue.
2445
2446 Example of a header received by the application server :
2447 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2448 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2449
2450 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2451
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002452http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002453 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002454 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2455
2456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2457 no | yes | yes | yes
2458
2459 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2460 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2461 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002462 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2463 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002464 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2465
2466 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2467 instance.
2468
2469 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002470 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2471 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2472 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002473
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002474 http-request allow if nagios
2475 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2476 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2477 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002478
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002479 Example:
2480 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002481
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002482 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002483
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002484 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2485 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002487id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002488 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2490 no | yes | yes | yes
2491 Arguments : none
2492
2493 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2494 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2495 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002496
2497
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002498ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2499 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2501 no | yes | yes | yes
2502
2503 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2504 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2505 and running).
2506
2507 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2508 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2509 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2510 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2511 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2512
2513 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2514 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2515
2516 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2517 "unless" condition is met.
2518
2519 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2520
2521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002522log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002523log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002524 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2526 yes | yes | yes | yes
2527 Arguments :
2528 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2529 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2530 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2531 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2532 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2533 parameter.
2534
2535 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2536 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2537
2538 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2539 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2540 standard syslog port).
2541
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002542 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2543 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2544 standard syslog port).
2545
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002546 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2547 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2548 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2549 appropriately writeable).
2550
2551 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2552
2553 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2554 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2555 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2556
2557 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2558 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2559 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002560 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2561 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2562 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2563 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2564 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002565
2566 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2567
2568 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2569 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2570 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2571
2572 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002573 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2574 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2575 "info".
2576
2577 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2578 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2579 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2580 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2581
2582 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2583 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002584
2585 Example :
2586 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002587 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2588 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002589
2590
2591maxconn <conns>
2592 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2594 yes | yes | yes | no
2595 Arguments :
2596 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2597 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2598 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2599 closes.
2600
2601 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2602 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2603 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2604 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2605 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2606 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2607 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2608 properly tuned.
2609
2610 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2611 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2612 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2613
2614 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2615
2616
2617mode { tcp|http|health }
2618 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 yes | yes | yes | yes
2621 Arguments :
2622 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2623 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2624 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2625 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2626
2627 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2628 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2629 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2630 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2631 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2632
2633 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2634 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2635 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2636 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2637 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2638 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2639
2640 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2641 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2642 will be refused.
2643
2644 Example :
2645 defaults http_instances
2646 mode http
2647
2648 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002651monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002652 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002655 Arguments :
2656 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2657 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002658 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002659 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2660 backend and its backup.
2661
2662 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2663 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2664 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2665 servers in a list of backends.
2666
2667 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2668 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2669 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2670 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2671 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2672 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2673 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002674 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2675 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002676
2677 Example:
2678 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002679 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2681 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2682 monitor-uri /site_alive
2683 monitor fail if site_dead
2684
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002685 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686
2687
2688monitor-net <source>
2689 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2691 yes | yes | yes | no
2692 Arguments :
2693 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2694 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2695 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2696 followed by a mask.
2697
2698 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2699 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002700 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2702
2703 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2704 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2705 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2706 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2707 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2708
2709 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2710 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2711 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2712 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2713 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2714
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002715 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2716 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2717
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002718 Example :
2719 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2720 frontend www
2721 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2722
2723 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2724
2725
2726monitor-uri <uri>
2727 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2729 yes | yes | yes | no
2730 Arguments :
2731 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2732 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2733
2734 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2735 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2736 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2737 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2738 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2739 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2740 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2741 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2742
2743 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2744 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2745 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2746 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2747 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2748 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2749
2750 Example :
2751 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2752 frontend www
2753 mode http
2754 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2755
2756 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002759option abortonclose
2760no option abortonclose
2761 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2763 yes | no | yes | yes
2764 Arguments : none
2765
2766 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2767 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2768 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2769 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002770 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002771 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2772 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2773 encountered while delivering the response.
2774
2775 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2776 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2777 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2778 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2779 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2780 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002781 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002782 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002783 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002784 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2785 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2786 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2787
2788 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2789 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2790 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2791 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2792 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2793 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2794 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2795 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002796 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002797
2798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2800
2801 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2802
2803
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002804option accept-invalid-http-request
2805no option accept-invalid-http-request
2806 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2808 yes | yes | yes | no
2809 Arguments : none
2810
2811 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2812 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2813 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2814 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2815 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2816 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2817 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2818 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2819 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2820
2821 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2822 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2823 been confirmed.
2824
2825 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2826 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2827 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2828 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2829
2830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2832
2833 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2834 stats socket.
2835
2836
2837option accept-invalid-http-response
2838no option accept-invalid-http-response
2839 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2841 yes | no | yes | yes
2842 Arguments : none
2843
2844 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2845 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2846 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2847 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2848 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2849 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2850 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2851 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2852 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2853
2854 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2855 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2856 been confirmed.
2857
2858 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2859 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2860 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2861 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2862
2863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2865
2866 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2867 stats socket.
2868
2869
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002870option allbackups
2871no option allbackups
2872 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2874 yes | no | yes | yes
2875 Arguments : none
2876
2877 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2878 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2879 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2880 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2881 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2882 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2883 order between the backup servers anymore.
2884
2885 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2886 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2887
2888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2890
2891
2892option checkcache
2893no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002894 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2896 yes | no | yes | yes
2897 Arguments : none
2898
2899 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2900 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002901 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002902 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2903 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2904 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2905
2906 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002907 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002908 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002909 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2910 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002911 to the client are :
2912 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002913 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002914 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002915 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2916 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2917 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2918 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2919 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2920 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2921 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2922 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2923 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2924 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2925 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2926
2927 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002928 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002929 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002930 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002931 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2932
2933 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2934 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002935 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002936 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2937
2938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2940
2941
2942option clitcpka
2943no option clitcpka
2944 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | no
2947 Arguments : none
2948
2949 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2950 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2951 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2952 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2953
2954 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2955 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2956 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2957 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2958
2959 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2960 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2961 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2962 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2963 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2964
2965 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2966
2967 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2968 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2969 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2970
2971 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2972 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2973
2974 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2975
2976
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002977option contstats
2978 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 yes | yes | yes | no
2981 Arguments : none
2982
2983 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2984 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2985 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2986 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2987 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2988 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2989 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2990
2991
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002992option dontlog-normal
2993no option dontlog-normal
2994 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 yes | yes | yes | no
2997 Arguments : none
2998
2999 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3000 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3001 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3002 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3003 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3004 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3005 logged.
3006
3007 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3008 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3009 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003011 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003012 logging.
3013
3014
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003015option dontlognull
3016no option dontlognull
3017 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3019 yes | yes | yes | no
3020 Arguments : none
3021
3022 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3023 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3024 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3025 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3026 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3027 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3028 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3029
3030 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3031 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3032 would not be logged.
3033
3034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003037 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003038
3039
3040option forceclose
3041no option forceclose
3042 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003045 Arguments : none
3046
3047 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3048 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3049 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3050 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3051 global session times in the logs.
3052
3053 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003054 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003055 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3056 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3057 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3058 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003059
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003060 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3061 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3062 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3063
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3066
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003067 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003068
3069
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003070option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003071 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3073 yes | yes | yes | yes
3074 Arguments :
3075 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3076 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003077 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003078 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003079
3080 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3081 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3082 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3083 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3084 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3085 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3086 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003087 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3088 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3089 possible that the client has already brought one.
3090
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003091 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003092 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003093 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3094 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003095 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3096 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003097
3098 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3099 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3100 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3101 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3102 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3103 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3104 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3105
3106 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003107 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3108 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3109 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003110
3111 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3112 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3113 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3114 when using this option.
3115
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003116 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003117 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3118 frontend www
3119 mode http
3120 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3121
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003122 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3123 backend www
3124 mode http
3125 option forwardfor header X-Client
3126
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003127 See also : "option httpclose"
3128
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003129
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003130option http-no-delay
3131no option http-no-delay
3132 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 yes | yes | yes | yes
3135 Arguments : none
3136
3137 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3138 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3139 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3140 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3141 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3142 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3143 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3144 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3145 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3146 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3147 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3148 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3149 affected.
3150
3151 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3152 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3153 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3154 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3155 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3156 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3157 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3158 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3159 latency environments.
3160
3161
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003162option http-pretend-keepalive
3163no option http-pretend-keepalive
3164 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3166 yes | yes | yes | yes
3167 Arguments : none
3168
3169 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3170 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3171 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3172 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3173 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3174 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3175 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3176 consider the response complete.
3177
3178 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3179 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3180 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3181 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3182 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3183 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3184
3185 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3186 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3187 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3188 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3189 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3190 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3191 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3192
3193 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3194 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003195 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3196 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3197 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003198
3199 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3200 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3201
3202 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3203
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003204
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003205option http-server-close
3206no option http-server-close
3207 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 yes | yes | yes | yes
3210 Arguments : none
3211
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003212 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3213 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3214 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3215 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3216 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3217 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3218 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3219 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3220 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3221 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3222 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3223 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003224
3225 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3226 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3227 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3228 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003229 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3230 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003231
3232 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3233 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003234 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3235 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3236 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003237
3238 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3239 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3240
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003241 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3242 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003243
3244
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003245option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003246no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003247 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3249 yes | yes | yes | no
3250 Arguments : none
3251
3252 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3253 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3254 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3255 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3256 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3257 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3258 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3259
3260 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3261 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3262 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3263 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3264 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3265 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3266 request along its whole life.
3267
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003268 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3269 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3270 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3271 front of an existing proxy.
3272
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003273 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3274
3275 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3276 http-server-close".
3277
3278
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003279option httpchk
3280option httpchk <uri>
3281option httpchk <method> <uri>
3282option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3283 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3285 yes | no | yes | yes
3286 Arguments :
3287 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3288 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3289 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3290 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3291 ones.
3292
3293 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3294 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3295 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3296
3297 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3298 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3299 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3300 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3301 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3302
3303 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3304 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3305 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3306 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3307 the lack of any response.
3308
3309 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3310
3311 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3312 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3313 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3314
3315 Examples :
3316 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3317 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3318 backend https_relay
3319 mode tcp
3320 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3321 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3322
3323 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003324 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3325 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003326
3327
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003328option httpclose
3329no option httpclose
3330 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | yes | yes | yes
3333 Arguments : none
3334
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003335 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3336 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3337 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3338 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3339 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3340 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3341 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003342
3343 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003344 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3345 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3346 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3347 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3348 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3349 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003350
3351 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3352 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3353 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003354 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3355 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003356
3357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3359
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003360 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3361 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003362
3363
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003364option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003365 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3367 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003368 Arguments :
3369 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3370 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3371 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3372 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3373 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003374
3375 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3376 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3377 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3378 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3379 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3380 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3381 ports.
3382
3383 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3384
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003385 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3386 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3387 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3388 by default.
3389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003390 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003391
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003392
3393option http_proxy
3394no option http_proxy
3395 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 yes | yes | yes | yes
3398 Arguments : none
3399
3400 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3401 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3402 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3403 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3404 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3405
3406 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3407 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3408 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3409 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003410 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003411 be analyzed.
3412
3413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3415
3416 Example :
3417 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3418 backend direct_forward
3419 option httpclose
3420 option http_proxy
3421
3422 See also : "option httpclose"
3423
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003424
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003425option independant-streams
3426no option independant-streams
3427 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 yes | yes | yes | yes
3430 Arguments : none
3431
3432 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3433 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3434 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3435 receive data or not.
3436
3437 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3438 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3439 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3440 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3441 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3442 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3443 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3444 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3445 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3446 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3447 socket buffers.
3448
3449 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3450 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3451 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3452 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3453 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3454
3455 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3456
3457
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003458option ldap-check
3459 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | no | yes | yes
3462 Arguments : none
3463
3464 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3465 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3466 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3467 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3468
3469 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3470 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3471
3472 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3473 configure it.
3474
3475 Example :
3476 option ldap-check
3477
3478 See also : "option httpchk"
3479
3480
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003481option log-health-checks
3482no option log-health-checks
3483 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3485 yes | no | yes | yes
3486 Arguments : none
3487
3488 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3489 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3490 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3491 of additional information is limited.
3492
3493 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3494 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3495
3496 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3497
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003498
3499option log-separate-errors
3500no option log-separate-errors
3501 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3503 yes | yes | yes | no
3504 Arguments : none
3505
3506 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3507 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3508 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3509 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3510 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3511 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3512 provides very important information.
3513
3514 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3515 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3516 error logs.
3517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003518 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003519 logging.
3520
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003521
3522option logasap
3523no option logasap
3524 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | yes | yes | no
3527 Arguments : none
3528
3529 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3530 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3531 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3532 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3533 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3534 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3535 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003536 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003537 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3538 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3539
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003540 Examples :
3541 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3542 mode http
3543 option httplog
3544 option logasap
3545 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3546
3547 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3548 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3549 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3550 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003552 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003553 logging.
3554
3555
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003556option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3557 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3559 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003560 Arguments :
3561 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3562 to MySQL server.
3563
3564 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3565 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3566 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3567 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3568 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3569 in the MySQL table, like this :
3570
3571 USE mysql;
3572 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3573 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3574
3575 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3576 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3577 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3578 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3579 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3580 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3581 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3582 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3583 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3584
3585 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3586 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003587
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003588 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003589
3590 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3591 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3592 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3593 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3594 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3595 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3596
3597 See also: "option httpchk"
3598
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003599option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3600 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3602 yes | no | yes | yes
3603 Arguments :
3604 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3605 to PostgreSQL server.
3606
3607 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3608 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3609 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3610 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3611
3612 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003613
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003614option nolinger
3615no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003616 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003619 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003620
3621 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3622 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3623 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3624 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3625 connections.
3626
3627 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3628 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3629 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3630 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3631 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3632 this too.
3633
3634 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3635 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3636 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3637
3638 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3639 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3640 for servers.
3641
3642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3644
3645
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003646option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3647 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | yes | yes | yes
3650 Arguments :
3651 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3652 matching <network>
3653 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3654 header name.
3655
3656 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3657 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3658 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3659 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3660 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3661 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3662 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3663 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3664 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3665 possible that the client has already brought one.
3666
3667 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3668 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3669 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3670 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3671 header and requires different one.
3672
3673 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3674 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3675 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3676 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3677 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3678 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3679 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3680
3681 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3682 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3683 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3684 both are defined.
3685
3686 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3687 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3688 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3689 when using this option.
3690
3691 Examples :
3692 # Original Destination address
3693 frontend www
3694 mode http
3695 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3696
3697 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3698 backend www
3699 mode http
3700 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3701
3702 See also : "option httpclose"
3703
3704
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003705option persist
3706no option persist
3707 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3708 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3709 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003710 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003711
3712 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3713 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3714 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3715 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3716 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3717 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3718 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3719 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3720 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3721 redirected to another valid server.
3722
3723 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3724 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3725
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003726 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003727
3728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003729option redispatch
3730no option redispatch
3731 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3732 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3733 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003734 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003735
3736 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3737 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3738 be able to access the service anymore.
3739
3740 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3741 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3742
3743 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3744 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3745 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003747 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3748 "redisp" keywords.
3749
3750 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3751 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3752
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003753 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003754
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003755
3756option smtpchk
3757option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3758 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3760 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003762 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3763 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3764 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3765
3766 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3767 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3768 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3769
3770 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3771 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3772 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3773 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3774 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3775 dead server.
3776
3777 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3778 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3779 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3780 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3781
3782 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3783 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3784 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3785 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3786 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3787
3788 Example :
3789 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3790
3791 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003794option socket-stats
3795no option socket-stats
3796
3797 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3799 yes | yes | yes | no
3800
3801 Arguments : none
3802
3803
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003804option splice-auto
3805no option splice-auto
3806 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3808 yes | yes | yes | yes
3809 Arguments : none
3810
3811 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3812 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3813 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3814 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003815 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003816 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3817 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3818 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3819 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3820
3821 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3822 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3823 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3824 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3825 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3826 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3827 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3828 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3829 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3830 keyword.
3831
3832 Example :
3833 option splice-auto
3834
3835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3837
3838 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3839 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3840
3841
3842option splice-request
3843no option splice-request
3844 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 yes | yes | yes | yes
3847 Arguments : none
3848
3849 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3850 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3851 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3852 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3853 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3854 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3855
3856 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3857
3858 Example :
3859 option splice-request
3860
3861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3863
3864 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3865 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3866
3867
3868option splice-response
3869no option splice-response
3870 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3872 yes | yes | yes | yes
3873 Arguments : none
3874
3875 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3876 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3877 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3878 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3879 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3880 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3881
3882 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3883
3884 Example :
3885 option splice-response
3886
3887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3889
3890 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3891 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3892
3893
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003894option srvtcpka
3895no option srvtcpka
3896 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3898 yes | no | yes | yes
3899 Arguments : none
3900
3901 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3902 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3903 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3904 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3905
3906 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3907 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3908 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3909 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3910
3911 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3912 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3913 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3914 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3915 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3916
3917 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3918
3919 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3920 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3921 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3922
3923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3925
3926 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3927
3928
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003929option ssl-hello-chk
3930 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 yes | no | yes | yes
3933 Arguments : none
3934
3935 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3936 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3937 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3938 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3939 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3940 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3941 hello message.
3942
3943 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3944 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3945 messages, which is appreciable.
3946
3947 See also: "option httpchk"
3948
3949
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003950option tcp-smart-accept
3951no option tcp-smart-accept
3952 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3954 yes | yes | yes | no
3955 Arguments : none
3956
3957 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3958 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3959 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3960 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3961 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3962 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3963
3964 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3965 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3966 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3967 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3968
3969 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3970 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3971 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3972 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3973
3974 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3975 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3976 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3977
3978 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3979 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3980 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3981
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003982 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3983
3984
3985option tcp-smart-connect
3986no option tcp-smart-connect
3987 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3989 yes | no | yes | yes
3990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3993 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3994 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3995 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3996 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3997
3998 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3999 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4000 complex.
4001
4002 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4003 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4004 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4005
4006 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4007 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4008
4009 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4010
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004011
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004012option tcpka
4013 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4015 yes | yes | yes | yes
4016 Arguments : none
4017
4018 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4019 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4020 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4021 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4022
4023 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4024 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4025 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4026 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4027
4028 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4029 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4030 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4031 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4032 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4033
4034 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4035
4036 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4037 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4038 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4039 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4040 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4041 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4042 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4043 backends.
4044
4045 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4046
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004047
4048option tcplog
4049 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4051 yes | yes | yes | yes
4052 Arguments : none
4053
4054 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4055 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4056 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4057 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4058 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4059 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4060 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4061 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4062
4063 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004065 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004066
4067
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004068option transparent
4069no option transparent
4070 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004072 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004073 Arguments : none
4074
4075 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4076 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4077 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4078 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4079 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4080 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4081 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4082 appropriate server.
4083
4084 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4085 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4086
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004087 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004088 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004089
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004090
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004091persist rdp-cookie
4092persist rdp-cookie(name)
4093 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | no | yes | yes
4096 Arguments :
4097 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004098 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4099 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004100
4101 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4102 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4103 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4104 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4105 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4106 forwarded to this server.
4107
4108 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4109 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4110 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004111 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004112 a single "listen" section.
4113
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004114 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4115 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4116 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4117
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004118 Example :
4119 listen tse-farm
4120 bind :3389
4121 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4122 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4123 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4124 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4125 persist rdp-cookie
4126 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4127 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4128 balance rdp-cookie
4129 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4130 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4131
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004132 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4133 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004134
4135
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004136rate-limit sessions <rate>
4137 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4139 yes | yes | yes | no
4140 Arguments :
4141 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4142 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4143
4144 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4145 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4146 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4147 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4148 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4149 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4150
4151 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4152 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4153 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4154 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4155
4156 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4157 listen smtp
4158 mode tcp
4159 bind :25
4160 rate-limit sessions 10
4161 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4162
4163 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4164 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4165
4166 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4167
4168
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004169redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4170redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004171 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4173 no | yes | yes | yes
4174
4175 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004176 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004177
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004178 Arguments :
4179 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4180 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4181 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4182 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004183 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4184 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4185 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4186 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004187
4188 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4189 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4190 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4191 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4192 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4193 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4194 location with a GET method.
4195
4196 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4197 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4198
4199 - "drop-query"
4200 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4201 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4202 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4203 with a location-type redirect.
4204
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004205 - "append-slash"
4206 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4207 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4208 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4209 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4210
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004211 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4212 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4213 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4214 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4215 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4216 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4217 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4218
4219 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4220 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4221 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4222 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4223 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4224 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4225 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004226
4227 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4228 acl clear dst_port 80
4229 acl secure dst_port 8080
4230 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004231 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004232 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004233 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4234
4235 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004236 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4237 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4238 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004239 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004240
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004241 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4242 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4243 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004245 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004246
4247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004248redisp (deprecated)
4249redispatch (deprecated)
4250 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004253 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004254
4255 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4256 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4257 be able to access the service anymore.
4258
4259 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4260 redistribute them to a working server.
4261
4262 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4263 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4264 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004266 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4267 "option redispatch" instead.
4268
4269 See also : "option redispatch"
4270
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004271
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004272reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004273 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4275 no | yes | yes | yes
4276 Arguments :
4277 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4278 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004279 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004280
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004281 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4282 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4283
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004284 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4285 the last header of an HTTP request.
4286
4287 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4288 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4289 responses.
4290
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004291 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4292 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4293 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4294
4295 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4296 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004297
4298
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004299reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4300reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004301 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4303 no | yes | yes | yes
4304 Arguments :
4305 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4306 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4307 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4308 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4309 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4310 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4311 ignores case.
4312
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004313 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4314 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4315
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004316 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4317 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4318 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4319 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004320 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004321
4322 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4323 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4324
4325 Example :
4326 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4327 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4328 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4329
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004330 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4331 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004332
4333
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004334reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4335reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004336 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4338 no | yes | yes | yes
4339 Arguments :
4340 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4341 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4342 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4343 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4344 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4345 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4346
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004347 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4348 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4349
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004350 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4351 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4352 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4353 next servers.
4354
4355 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4356 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4357 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4358
4359 Example :
4360 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4361 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4362 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4363
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004364 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4365 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004366
4367
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004368reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4369reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004370 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 no | yes | yes | yes
4373 Arguments :
4374 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4375 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4376 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4377 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4378 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4379 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4380 case.
4381
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004382 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4383 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4384
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004385 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4386 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4387 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4388 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004389 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004390
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004391 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004392 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004393 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004394
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004395 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4396 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4397
4398 Example :
4399 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4400 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4401 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4402
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004403 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4404 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004405
4406
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004407reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4408reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004409 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 no | yes | yes | yes
4412 Arguments :
4413 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4414 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4415 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4416 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4417 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4418 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4419 case.
4420
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004421 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4422 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4423
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004424 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4425 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4426 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4427 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4428
4429 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4430 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4431
4432 Example :
4433 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4434 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4435 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4436 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4437
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004438 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4439 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004440
4441
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004442reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4443reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004444 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 no | yes | yes | yes
4447 Arguments :
4448 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4449 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4450 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4451 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4452 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4453 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4454
4455 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4456 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4457 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4458 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004459 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004461 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4462 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4463
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004464 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4465 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4466 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4467
4468 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4469 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4470 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4471 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4472 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4473
4474 Example :
4475 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4476 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4477 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4478 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4479
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004480 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4481 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004482
4483
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004484reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4485reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004486 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 no | yes | yes | yes
4489 Arguments :
4490 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4491 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4492 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4493 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4494 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4495 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4496 ignores case.
4497
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004498 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4499 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4500
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004501 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4502 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004503 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4504 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4505 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4507 not set.
4508
4509 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4510 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4511 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4512 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4513 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4514
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004515 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004516 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4517 # block all others.
4518 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4519 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4520
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004521 # block bad guys
4522 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4523 reqitarpit . if badguys
4524
4525 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4526 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004527
4528
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004529retries <value>
4530 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | no | yes | yes
4533 Arguments :
4534 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4535 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4536 default value is 3.
4537
4538 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4539 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4540 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4541
4542 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4543 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4544
4545 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4546 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4547
4548 See also : "option redispatch"
4549
4550
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004551rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4554 no | yes | yes | yes
4555 Arguments :
4556 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4557 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004558 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004559
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004560 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4561 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4562
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004563 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4564 the last header of an HTTP response.
4565
4566 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4567 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4568 responses.
4569
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004570 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4571 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004572
4573
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004574rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4575rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004576 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4578 no | yes | yes | yes
4579 Arguments :
4580 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4581 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4582 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4583 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4584 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4585 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4586 ignores case.
4587
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004588 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4589 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4590
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004591 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4592 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4593 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4594 client.
4595
4596 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4597 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4598 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4599
4600 Example :
4601 # remove the Server header from responses
4602 reqidel ^Server:.*
4603
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004604 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4605 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004606
4607
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004608rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4609rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004610 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 no | yes | yes | yes
4613 Arguments :
4614 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4615 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4616 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4617 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4618 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4619 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4620 ignores case.
4621
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004622 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4623 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4624
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004625 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4626 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4627 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4628 case-sensitive.
4629
4630 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004631 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4632 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4633 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004634
4635 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4636 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4637
4638 Example :
4639 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4640 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4641
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004642 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4643 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004644
4645
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004646rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4647rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004648 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4650 no | yes | yes | yes
4651 Arguments :
4652 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4653 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4654 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4655 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4656 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4657 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4658 ignores case.
4659
4660 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4661 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4662 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4663 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004664 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004665
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004666 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4667 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4668
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004669 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4670 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4671 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4672
4673 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4674 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4675 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4676 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4677 are not case-sensitive.
4678
4679 Example :
4680 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4681 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4682
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004683 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4684 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004685
4686
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004687server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004688 Declare a server in a backend
4689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4690 no | no | yes | yes
4691 Arguments :
4692 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4693 appear in logs and alerts.
4694
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004695 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4696 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4697 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4698 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004699 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4700 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4701 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4702 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4703 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4704 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004705
4706 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4707 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4708 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4709 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4710 adding this value to the client's port.
4711
4712 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4713 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004714 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004715
4716 Examples :
4717 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4718 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004720 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004721
4722
4723source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004724source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004725source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004726 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 yes | no | yes | yes
4729 Arguments :
4730 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4731 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4732 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4733 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4734
4735 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4736 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004737 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4738 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4739 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004740
4741 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4742 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4743 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4744 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4745 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4746 <addr>.
4747
4748 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4749 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4750 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4751 port.
4752
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004753 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4754 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4755 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4756 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4757 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4758 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4759 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4760 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4761 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4762 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4763 HTTP header.
4764
4765 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4766 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4767 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4768 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4769 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4770 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4771 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4772 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4773 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4774 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4775
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004776 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4777 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4778 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4779 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4780 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4781 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4782
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004783 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4784 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4785 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4786 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4787
4788 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4789 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4790 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4791 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4792 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4793 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4794
4795 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4796 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4797 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4798 there are two methods :
4799
4800 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4801 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4802 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4803 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4804 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4805 of the client ranges may be used.
4806
4807 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4808 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4809 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4810 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4811 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4812 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4813 same session.
4814
4815 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4816 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4817 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4818 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4819 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4820 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4821
4822 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4823 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4824 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004825 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004826
4827 Examples :
4828 backend private
4829 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4830 source 192.168.1.200
4831
4832 backend transparent_ssl1
4833 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4834 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4835
4836 backend transparent_ssl2
4837 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4838 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4839 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4840
4841 backend transparent_ssl3
4842 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4843 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4844 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4845
4846 backend transparent_smtp
4847 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4848 # with Tproxy version 4.
4849 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4850
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004851 backend transparent_http
4852 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4853 # proxy.
4854 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004856 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004857 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004859
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004860srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4861 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 yes | no | yes | yes
4864 Arguments :
4865 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4867 as explained at the top of this document.
4868
4869 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4870 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4871 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4872 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4873 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4874 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4875 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4876
4877 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4878 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4879 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4880 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4881 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004882 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004883 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004884 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004885
4886 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4887 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4888 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4889 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4890 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4891 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4892
4893 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4894 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4895
4896 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4897
4898
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004899stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4900 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4902 no | no | yes | yes
4903
4904 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4905 matched.
4906
4907 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4908 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4909
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004910 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4911 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4912 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4913
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004914 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4915 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4916 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4917 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004918
4919 Example :
4920 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4921 backend stats_localhost
4922 stats enable
4923 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4924
4925 Example :
4926 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4927 backend stats_auth
4928 stats enable
4929 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4930 stats admin if TRUE
4931
4932 Example :
4933 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4934 userlist stats-auth
4935 group admin users admin
4936 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4937 group readonly users haproxy
4938 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4939
4940 backend stats_auth
4941 stats enable
4942 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4943 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4944 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4945 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4946
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004947 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4948 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4949 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004950
4951
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004952stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4953 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | no | yes | yes
4956 Arguments :
4957 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4958
4959 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4960
4961 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4962 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4963 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4964 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4965 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4966 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4967
4968 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4969 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4970 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4971 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4972
4973 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4974 report using "stats scope".
4975
4976 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4977 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4978 unobvious parameters.
4979
4980 Example :
4981 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4982 backend public_www
4983 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4984 stats enable
4985 stats hide-version
4986 stats scope .
4987 stats uri /admin?stats
4988 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4989 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4990 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4991
4992 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4993 backend private_monitoring
4994 stats enable
4995 stats uri /admin?stats
4996 stats refresh 5s
4997
4998 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4999
5000
5001stats enable
5002 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5004 yes | no | yes | yes
5005 Arguments : none
5006
5007 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5008 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5009 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5010 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5011 - stats auth : no authentication
5012 - stats scope : no restriction
5013
5014 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5015 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5016 unobvious parameters.
5017
5018 Example :
5019 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5020 backend public_www
5021 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5022 stats enable
5023 stats hide-version
5024 stats scope .
5025 stats uri /admin?stats
5026 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5027 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5028 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5029
5030 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5031 backend private_monitoring
5032 stats enable
5033 stats uri /admin?stats
5034 stats refresh 5s
5035
5036 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5037
5038
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005039stats hide-version
5040 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005043 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005044
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005045 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5046 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5047 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5048 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5049 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5050 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005052 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5053 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5054 unobvious parameters.
5055
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005056 Example :
5057 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5058 backend public_www
5059 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005060 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005061 stats hide-version
5062 stats scope .
5063 stats uri /admin?stats
5064 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5065 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5066 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005067
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005068 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5069 backend private_monitoring
5070 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005071 stats uri /admin?stats
5072 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005073
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005074 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005075
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005076
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005077stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5078 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5079 Access control for statistics
5080
5081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 no | no | yes | yes
5083
5084 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5085 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5086 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5087 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5088 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5089 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5090
5091 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5092 instance.
5093
5094 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5095 about ACL usage.
5096
5097
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005098stats realm <realm>
5099 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 yes | no | yes | yes
5102 Arguments :
5103 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5104 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5105 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5106
5107 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5108 using a backslash ('\').
5109
5110 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5111 only related to authentication.
5112
5113 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5114 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5115 unobvious parameters.
5116
5117 Example :
5118 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5119 backend public_www
5120 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5121 stats enable
5122 stats hide-version
5123 stats scope .
5124 stats uri /admin?stats
5125 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5126 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5127 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5128
5129 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5130 backend private_monitoring
5131 stats enable
5132 stats uri /admin?stats
5133 stats refresh 5s
5134
5135 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5136
5137
5138stats refresh <delay>
5139 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 yes | no | yes | yes
5142 Arguments :
5143 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5144 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5145 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5146 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5147 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5148 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5149
5150 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5151 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5152 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5153 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5154
5155 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5156 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5157 unobvious parameters.
5158
5159 Example :
5160 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5161 backend public_www
5162 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5163 stats enable
5164 stats hide-version
5165 stats scope .
5166 stats uri /admin?stats
5167 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5168 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5169 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5170
5171 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5172 backend private_monitoring
5173 stats enable
5174 stats uri /admin?stats
5175 stats refresh 5s
5176
5177 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5178
5179
5180stats scope { <name> | "." }
5181 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5183 yes | no | yes | yes
5184 Arguments :
5185 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5186 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5187 section in which the statement appears.
5188
5189 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5190 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5191 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5192 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5193 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5194 exists.
5195
5196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5198 unobvious parameters.
5199
5200 Example :
5201 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5202 backend public_www
5203 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5204 stats enable
5205 stats hide-version
5206 stats scope .
5207 stats uri /admin?stats
5208 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5209 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5210 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5211
5212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5213 backend private_monitoring
5214 stats enable
5215 stats uri /admin?stats
5216 stats refresh 5s
5217
5218 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5219
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005220
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005221stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005222 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 yes | no | yes | yes
5225
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005226 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005227 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5228
5229 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5230 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5231
5232 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5233 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5234 unobvious parameters.
5235
5236 Example :
5237 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5238 backend private_monitoring
5239 stats enable
5240 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5241 stats uri /admin?stats
5242 stats refresh 5s
5243
5244 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5245 global section.
5246
5247
5248stats show-legends
5249 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5250 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5251 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5252 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5253 - IP (socket, server)
5254 - cookie (backend, server)
5255
5256 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5257 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5258 unobvious parameters.
5259
5260 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5261
5262
5263stats show-node [ <name> ]
5264 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | no | yes | yes
5267 Arguments:
5268 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5269 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5270
5271 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5272 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5273 provided for each customer.
5274
5275 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5276 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5277 unobvious parameters.
5278
5279 Example:
5280 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5281 backend private_monitoring
5282 stats enable
5283 stats show-node Europe-1
5284 stats uri /admin?stats
5285 stats refresh 5s
5286
5287 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5288 section.
5289
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005290
5291stats uri <prefix>
5292 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5294 yes | no | yes | yes
5295 Arguments :
5296 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5297 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5298 query string.
5299
5300 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5301 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5302 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5303 possible to reach it in the application.
5304
5305 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005306 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005307 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5308 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5309 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5310 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5311
5312 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5313 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5314 an address or a port to statistics only.
5315
5316 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5317 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5318 unobvious parameters.
5319
5320 Example :
5321 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5322 backend public_www
5323 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5324 stats enable
5325 stats hide-version
5326 stats scope .
5327 stats uri /admin?stats
5328 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5329 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5330 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5331
5332 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5333 backend private_monitoring
5334 stats enable
5335 stats uri /admin?stats
5336 stats refresh 5s
5337
5338 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5339
5340
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005341stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5342 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005344 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005345
5346 Arguments :
5347 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5348 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5349 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5350 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5351
5352 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5353 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5354 the "stick-table" statement.
5355
5356 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5357 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5358 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5359 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5360 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5361
5362 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5363 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5364 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5365 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5366 transformation rules.
5367
5368 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5369 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5370 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5371 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5372 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5373 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5374 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5375
5376 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5377 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5378 ACL based conditions.
5379
5380 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5381 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5382 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5383 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5384
5385 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5386 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5387 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5388 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5389
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005390 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5391 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5392 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5393
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005394 Example :
5395 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5396 # last 30 minutes
5397 backend pop
5398 mode tcp
5399 balance roundrobin
5400 stick store-request src
5401 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5402 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5403 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5404
5405 backend smtp
5406 mode tcp
5407 balance roundrobin
5408 stick match src table pop
5409 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5410 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5411
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005412 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5413 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005414
5415
5416stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5417 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5419 no | no | yes | yes
5420
5421 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5422 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5423 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5424 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5425
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005426 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5427 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5428 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5429
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005430 Examples :
5431 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005432 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005433
5434 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5435 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5436 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5437
5438
5439 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5440 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5441 backend http
5442 mode http
5443 balance roundrobin
5444 stick on src table https
5445 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5446 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5447 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5448
5449 backend https
5450 mode tcp
5451 balance roundrobin
5452 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5453 stick on src
5454 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5455 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5456
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005457 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005458
5459
5460stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5461 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 no | no | yes | yes
5464
5465 Arguments :
5466 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5467 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5468 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5469 server is selected.
5470
5471 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5472 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5473 the "stick-table" statement.
5474
5475 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5476 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5477 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5478 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5479 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5480 address.
5481
5482 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5483 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5484 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5485 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5486 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5487 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5488 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5489 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5490 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5491 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5492
5493 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5494 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5495 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5496 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5497 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5498 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5499 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5500
5501 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5502 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5503 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5504 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5505
5506 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5507 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5508 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5509 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5510 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5511 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5512 another protocol or access method.
5513
5514 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5515 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5516 the request.
5517
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005518 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5519 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5520 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5521
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005522 Example :
5523 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5524 # last 30 minutes
5525 backend pop
5526 mode tcp
5527 balance roundrobin
5528 stick store-request src
5529 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5530 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5531 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5532
5533 backend smtp
5534 mode tcp
5535 balance roundrobin
5536 stick match src table pop
5537 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5538 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5539
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005540 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5541 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005542
5543
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005544stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005545 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5546 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005547 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005549 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005550
5551 Arguments :
5552 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5553 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5554 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5555 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5556
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005557 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5558 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5559 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5560 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5561
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005562 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5563 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5564 instance.
5565
5566 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5567 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5568 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5569 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5570 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5571 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005572 to 32 characters.
5573
5574 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5575 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5576 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5577 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5578 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5579 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005580
5581 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005582 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5583 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005584 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5585 increase.
5586
5587 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005588 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5589 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5590 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005591
5592 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5593 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5594 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5595 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5596 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5597 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5598 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5599 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5600 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5601 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5602 parameter (see below).
5603
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005604 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5605 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5606 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5607 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5608 soft restart.
5609
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005610 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5611
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005612 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5613 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5614 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5615 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5616 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5617 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5618 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5619 if not expiration delay is specified.
5620
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005621 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5622 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5623 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5624 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005625 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5626 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5627 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5628 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5629 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5630 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5631 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5632 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5633 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5634 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5635 types and their arguments.
5636
5637 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5638 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5639 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5640 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5641
5642 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5643 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5644 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5645 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5646
5647 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5648 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5649 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5650 they were received.
5651
5652 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5653 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5654 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5655 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5656 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5657
5658 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5659 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5660 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5661 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5662 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5663
5664 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5665 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5666 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5667
5668 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5669 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5670 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5671 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5672 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5673
5674 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5675 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5676 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5677 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5678 the client side.
5679
5680 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5681 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5682 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5683 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5684 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5685 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5686 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5687
5688 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5689 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5690 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5691 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5692 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5693 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5694 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5695
5696 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5697 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5698 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5699 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5700 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5701 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5702
5703 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5704 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5705 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5706 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5707
5708 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5709 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5710 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5711 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5712 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5713 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5714 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5715 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5716 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5717 recommended for better fairness.
5718
5719 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5720 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5721 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5722 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5723
5724 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5725 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5726 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5727 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5728 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5729 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5730 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5731 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5732 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5733 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005734
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005735 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5736 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005737 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5738 reference it.
5739
5740 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5741 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5742 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5743 as an exclusive stickiness.
5744
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005745 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5746 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5747 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5748 something that can be ignored.
5749
5750 Example:
5751 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5752 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5753 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5754 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5755
5756 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005757 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005758
5759
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005760stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5761 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5763 no | no | yes | yes
5764
5765 Arguments :
5766 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5767 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5768 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5769 server is selected.
5770
5771 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5772 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5773 the "stick-table" statement.
5774
5775 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5776 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5777 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5778 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5779
5780 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5781 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5782 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5783 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5784 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5785 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5786 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5787 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5788 rules.
5789
5790 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5791 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5792 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5793 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5794 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5795 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5796 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5797
5798 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5799 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5800 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5801 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5802
5803 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5804 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5805 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5806 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5807 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5808 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5809 another protocol or access method.
5810
5811 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5812
5813 Example :
5814 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5815 backend https
5816 mode tcp
5817 balance roundrobin
5818 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5819 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5820
5821 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5822 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5823
5824 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5825 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5826 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5827
5828 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5829 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5830
5831 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5832 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5833 # at offset 44.
5834
5835 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5836 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5837
5838 # Learn on response if server hello.
5839 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5840
5841 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5842 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5843
5844 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5845 extraction.
5846
5847
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005848tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5849 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005852 Arguments :
5853 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5854 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5855 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005857 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005858
5859 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5860 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005861 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5862 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5863 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5864 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5865 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5866 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005867
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005868 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5869 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5870 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5871 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005873 Three types of actions are supported :
5874 - accept :
5875 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5876 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5877 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005878
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005879 - reject :
5880 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5881 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5882 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5883 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5884 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5885 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5886 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5887 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5888 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5889 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5890 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5891 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005893 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5894 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5895 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5896 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5897 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5898 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5899 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5900 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5901 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005903 These actions take one or two arguments :
5904 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5905 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5906 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005908 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5909 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5910 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5911 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005913 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5914 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5915 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5916 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5917 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5918 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5919 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5920 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5921 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5922 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005924 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5925 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5926 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005927
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005928 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5929 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5930 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005932 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005933 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005934 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005936 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5937 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5938 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005939
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005940 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5941 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5942 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005943
5944 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005946 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005947
5948
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005949tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5950 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005952 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005953 Arguments :
5954 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5955 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5956 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005958 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005960 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5961 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5962 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5963 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5964 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005966 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5967 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5968 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5969 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5970 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5971 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5972 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5973 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5974 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005976 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5977 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5978 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5979 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005980
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005981 Three types of actions are supported :
5982 - accept :
5983 - reject :
5984 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005986 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5987 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005989 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5990 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5991 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5992 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5993 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5994 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005996 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005997 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5998 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005999
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006000 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6001 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6002 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6003 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6004 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006005
6006 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006007 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6008 # and reject everything else.
6009 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6010 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6011 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6012 tcp-request content reject
6013
6014 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006015 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6016 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6017 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006018 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006019
6020 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6021 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6022 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006023 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006024 tcp-request content reject
6025
6026 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6027 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6028
6029 frontend http
6030 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6031 # protecting all our sites
6032 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6033 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6034 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6035 ...
6036 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6037
6038 backend http_dynamic
6039 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6040 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6041 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6042 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6043 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6044 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6045 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006047 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006049 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006050
6051
6052tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6053 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006055 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006056 Arguments :
6057 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6058 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6059 as explained at the top of this document.
6060
6061 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6062 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6063 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6064 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6065 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6066
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006067 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6068 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6069 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6070 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6071
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006072 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6073 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006074 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006075 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006076 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6077 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6078 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6079 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006080
6081 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6082 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6083 it pass through unaffected.
6084
6085 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6086 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6087 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006088 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006089 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6090 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006091 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6092 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6093 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006094
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006095 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006096 "timeout client".
6097
6098
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006099tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6100 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 no | no | yes | yes
6103 Arguments :
6104 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6105 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6106 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6107
6108 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6109
6110 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6111 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6112 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6113 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6114 set and expires with no matching rule.
6115
6116 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6117
6118 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6119 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6120 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6121 inserted.
6122
6123 Two types of actions are supported :
6124 - accept :
6125 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6126 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6127 the rules evaluation.
6128
6129 - reject :
6130 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6131 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6132 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6133
6134 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6135 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6136 for changing the default action to a reject.
6137
6138 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6139 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6140 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6141 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6142 period.
6143
6144 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6145
6146 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6147
6148
6149tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6150 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6152 no | no | yes | yes
6153 Arguments :
6154 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6155 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6156 as explained at the top of this document.
6157
6158 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6159
6160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006161timeout check <timeout>
6162 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6163 established.
6164
6165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 yes | no | yes | yes
6167 Arguments:
6168 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6169 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6170 as explained at the top of this document.
6171
6172 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6173 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6174 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6175 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006176 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6177 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6178 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006179
6180 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6181 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6182
6183 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6184 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006185 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006186
6187 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6188 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6189 forget about it.
6190
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006191 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6192 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006193
6194
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006195timeout client <timeout>
6196timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6197 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6199 yes | yes | yes | no
6200 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006201 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006202 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6203 as explained at the top of this document.
6204
6205 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6206 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6207 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6208 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6209 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6210 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6211 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6212 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006213 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006214 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6215 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6216
6217 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6218 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6219 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6220 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6221 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6222 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6223
6224 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6225 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6226 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6227
6228 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6229
6230
6231timeout connect <timeout>
6232timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6233 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6235 yes | no | yes | yes
6236 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006237 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006238 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6239 as explained at the top of this document.
6240
6241 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006242 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006243 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006244 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006245 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6246 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006247
6248 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6249 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6250 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6251 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6252 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6253 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6254
6255 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6256 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6257 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6258
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006259 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6260 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006261
6262
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006263timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6264 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | yes | yes | yes
6267 Arguments :
6268 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6269 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6270 as explained at the top of this document.
6271
6272 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6273 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6274 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6275 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6276 once the request has started to present itself.
6277
6278 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6279 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6280 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6281 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6282 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6283
6284 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6285 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6286 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6287 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6288
6289 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6290 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6291 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6292 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6293 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006294 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006295
6296 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6297 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6298 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6299 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6300
6301 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6302
6303
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006304timeout http-request <timeout>
6305 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006307 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006309 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006310 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6311 as explained at the top of this document.
6312
6313 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6314 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6315 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6316 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6317 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6318 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6319 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6320 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6321
6322 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6323 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006324 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6325 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006326
6327 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6328 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6329 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6330 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6331 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6332
6333 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006334 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6335 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6336 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006337
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006338 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006339
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006340
6341timeout queue <timeout>
6342 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6344 yes | no | yes | yes
6345 Arguments :
6346 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6347 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6348 as explained at the top of this document.
6349
6350 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6351 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6352 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6353 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6354 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6355
6356 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6357 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6358 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6359 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6360
6361 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6362
6363
6364timeout server <timeout>
6365timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6366 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6368 yes | no | yes | yes
6369 Arguments :
6370 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6371 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6372 as explained at the top of this document.
6373
6374 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6375 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6376 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6377 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6378 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6379 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6380 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6381
6382 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6383 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6384 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6385 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6386 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006387 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006388 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006389 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006390
6391 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6392 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6393 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6394 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6395 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6396 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6397
6398 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6399 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6400 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6401
6402 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6403
6404
6405timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006406 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6408 yes | yes | yes | yes
6409 Arguments :
6410 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6411 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6412 as explained at the top of this document.
6413
6414 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6415 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6416 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6417
6418 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6419 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6420 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6421 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006422 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006423
6424 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6425
6426
6427transparent (deprecated)
6428 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006430 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6434 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6435 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6436 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6437 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6438 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6439 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6440 appropriate server.
6441
6442 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6443
6444 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6445 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6446
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006447 See also: "option transparent"
6448
6449
6450use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6451use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006452 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 no | yes | yes | no
6455 Arguments :
6456 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006458 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006459
6460 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6461 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6462 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006463 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6464 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6465 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6466 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006467
6468 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6469 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6470 assign the backend.
6471
6472 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6473 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6474 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6475 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6476 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6477 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6478
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006479 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006480 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006481 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6482 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6483 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6484
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006485 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006486
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010064885. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006489------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006491The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6492which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6493arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6494settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6495after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6496Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6497address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006499 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006500 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006502The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006504addr <ipv4>
6505 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6506 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6507 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6508 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6509 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006511 Supported in default-server: No
6512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006513backup
6514 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6515 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6516 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6517 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6518 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6519 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006521 Supported in default-server: No
6522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006523check
6524 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6525 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6526 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6527 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6528 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6529 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6530 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6531 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6532 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01006533 "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to
6534 those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006536 Supported in default-server: No
6537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006538cookie <value>
6539 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6540 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6541 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6542 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6543 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6544 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6545 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006547 Supported in default-server: No
6548
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006549disabled
6550 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6551 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6552 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6553 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6554 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6555
6556 Supported in default-server: No
6557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006558error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006559 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6560 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6561 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006563 Supported in default-server: Yes
6564
6565 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006567fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006568 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6569 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6570 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006572 Supported in default-server: Yes
6573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006574id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006575 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6576 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6577 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006579 Supported in default-server: No
6580
6581inter <delay>
6582fastinter <delay>
6583downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006584 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6585 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6586 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6587 between checks depending on the server state :
6588
6589 Server state | Interval used
6590 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6591 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6592 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6593 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6594 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6595 or yet unchecked. |
6596 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6597 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6598 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006600 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6601 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6602 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6603 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6604 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6605 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6606 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6607 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6608 servers.
6609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006610 Supported in default-server: Yes
6611
6612maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006613 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6614 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6615 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6616 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6617 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6618 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6619 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6620 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006622 Supported in default-server: Yes
6623
6624maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006625 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6626 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6627 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6628 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6629 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6630 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6631 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006633 Supported in default-server: Yes
6634
6635minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006636 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6637 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6638 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6639 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6640 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6641 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006642 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006643 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006645 Supported in default-server: Yes
6646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006647observe <mode>
6648 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6649 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6650 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6651 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6652 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6653 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6654 headers, a timeout, etc.
6655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006656 Supported in default-server: No
6657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006658 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006660on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006661 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6662 Currently, four modes are available:
6663 - fastinter: force fastinter
6664 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6665 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6666 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6667 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006669 Supported in default-server: Yes
6670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006671 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6672
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006673on-marked-down <action>
6674 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6675 Currently one action is available:
6676 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6677
6678 Actions are disabled by default
6679
6680 Supported in default-server: Yes
6681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006682port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006683 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6684 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6685 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6686 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6687 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6688 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006690 Supported in default-server: Yes
6691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006692redir <prefix>
6693 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6694 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6695 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6696 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6697 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6698 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6699 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6700 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006701 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006702 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6703 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6704 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6705 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6706 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6707
6708 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006710 Supported in default-server: No
6711
6712rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006713 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6714 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6715 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006717 Supported in default-server: Yes
6718
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006719send-proxy
6720 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6721 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6722 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6723 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6724 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6725 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6726 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6727 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6728 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6729 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6730 option of the "bind" keyword.
6731
6732 Supported in default-server: No
6733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006734slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006735 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6736 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6737 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6738 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6739 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6740 parameters :
6741
6742 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6743 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6744
6745 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6746 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6747 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6748 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6749
6750 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6751 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6752 seen as failed.
6753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006754 Supported in default-server: Yes
6755
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006756source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006757source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006758source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006759 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6760 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6761 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6762 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6763
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006764 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6765 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6766 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6767 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6768 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6769 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6770 server.
6771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006772 Supported in default-server: No
6773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006774track [<proxy>/]<server>
6775 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6776 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6777 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6778 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6779 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006781 Supported in default-server: No
6782
6783weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006784 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6785 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6786 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006787 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6788 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6789 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6790 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6791 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6792 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006794 Supported in default-server: Yes
6795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006796
67976. HTTP header manipulation
6798---------------------------
6799
6800In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6801response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6802request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6803which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6804against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6805to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6806passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6807headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6808never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6809
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006810There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6811(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6812rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6813messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6814in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006815happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006816add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6817normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006819This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6820in section 4.2 :
6821
6822 - reqadd <string>
6823 - reqallow <search>
6824 - reqiallow <search>
6825 - reqdel <search>
6826 - reqidel <search>
6827 - reqdeny <search>
6828 - reqideny <search>
6829 - reqpass <search>
6830 - reqipass <search>
6831 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6832 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6833 - reqtarpit <search>
6834 - reqitarpit <search>
6835 - rspadd <string>
6836 - rspdel <search>
6837 - rspidel <search>
6838 - rspdeny <search>
6839 - rspideny <search>
6840 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6841 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6842
6843With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6844is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6845parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6846prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6847Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6848
6849 \t for a tab
6850 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6851 \n for a new line (LF)
6852 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6853 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6854 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6855 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6856 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6857
6858The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6859portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6860above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6861regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
68629 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6863is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6864
6865The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6866after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6867
6868Notes related to these keywords :
6869---------------------------------
6870 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6871 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6872 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6873
6874 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6875 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6876 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6877
6878 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6879 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6880 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6881 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6882 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6883
6884 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6885 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6886 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6887 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6888 useless headers before adding new ones.
6889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006890 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006891 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6892
6893 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6894 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6895 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6896
6897 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6898 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006899 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006900
6901
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010069027. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6903------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006904
6905The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6906content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6907from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6908simple :
6909
6910 - define test criteria with sets of values
6911 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6912
6913The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6914
6915In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6916
6917 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6918
6919This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6920Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6921and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6922an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6923of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6924
6925ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6926'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6927which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6928
6929There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6930performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6931
6932The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6933
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006934 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6935 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006936 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6937
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006938The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6939specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6940possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006941multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6942be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6943needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6944space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6945match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6946lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6947duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6948to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6949instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006950
6951 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6952
6953In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6954the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6955case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6956too.
6957
6958Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6959a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6960ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6961
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006962Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006963
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006964 - integers or integer ranges
6965 - strings
6966 - regular expressions
6967 - IP addresses and networks
6968
6969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069707.1. Matching integers
6971----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006972
6973Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6974that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6975expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6976may be omitted.
6977
6978For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6979unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6980representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6981
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006982As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6983two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6984instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6985ranges and operators.
6986
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006987For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006988operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6989Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6990of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006992Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006993
6994 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6995 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6996 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6997 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6998 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007000For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007001
7002 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7003
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007004This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7005
7006 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7007
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070097.2. Matching strings
7010---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007011
7012String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7013exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7014characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7015string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7016to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007017before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007018
7019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070207.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7021-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007022
7023Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7024they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7025possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7026passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7027the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007028the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7029match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007030
7031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070327.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7033----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007034
7035IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7036netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7037within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007038host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007039difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7040at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7041does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7042parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007043
7044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070457.5. Available matching criteria
7046--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070487.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7049------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007050
7051A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7052analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7053addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7054
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007055always_false
7056 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7057 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7058
7059always_true
7060 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7061 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7062
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007063avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007064avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007065 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7066 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7067 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7068 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7069 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7070 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7071 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7072 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7073 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7074 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7075 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007076
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007077be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007078be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007079 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7080 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7081 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7082 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7083 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007084
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007085be_id <integer>
7086 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7087 backend it was called.
7088
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007089be_sess_rate <integer>
7090be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
7091 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7092 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7093 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7094 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7095 sucking of an online dictionary).
7096
7097 Example :
7098 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7099 backend dynamic
7100 mode http
7101 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7102 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007103
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007104connslots <integer>
7105connslots(backend) <integer>
7106 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007107 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007108 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7109
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007110 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7111 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007112
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007113 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007114 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7115 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7116 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7117 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7118 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007119 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007120
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007121 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7122 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7123 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7124 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007126dst <ip_address>
7127 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7128 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007129
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007130dst_conn <integer>
7131 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7132 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7133 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7134 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7135 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7136 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7137
7138dst_port <integer>
7139 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7140 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7141
7142fe_conn <integer>
7143fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7144 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7145 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7146 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7147 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7148 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7149 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7150 criteria.
7151
7152fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007153 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007154 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007155
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007156fe_sess_rate <integer>
7157fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7158 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7159 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7160 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7161 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7162 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7163 the rate to go down below the limit.
7164
7165 Example :
7166 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7167 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7168 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7169 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7170 frontend mail
7171 bind :25
7172 mode tcp
7173 maxconn 100
7174 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7175 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7176 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7177 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007178
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007179nbsrv <integer>
7180nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7181 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7182 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7183 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7184 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7185 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007186
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007187queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007188queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007189 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7190 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7191 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7192 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7193 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7194 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7195 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7196
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007197sc1_bytes_in_rate
7198sc2_bytes_in_rate
7199 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7200 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7201 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7202
7203sc1_bytes_out_rate
7204sc2_bytes_out_rate
7205 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7206 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7207 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7208
7209sc1_conn_cnt
7210sc2_conn_cnt
7211 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7212 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7213
7214sc1_conn_cur
7215sc2_conn_cur
7216 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7217 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7218 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7219
7220sc1_conn_rate
7221sc2_conn_rate
7222 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7223 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7224 See also src_conn_rate.
7225
7226sc1_get_gpc0
7227sc2_get_gpc0
7228 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7229 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7230
7231sc1_http_err_cnt
7232sc2_http_err_cnt
7233 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7234 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7235 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7236
7237sc1_http_err_rate
7238sc2_http_err_rate
7239 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7240 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7241 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7242 src_http_err_rate.
7243
7244sc1_http_req_cnt
7245sc2_http_req_cnt
7246 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7247 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7248 src_http_req_cnt.
7249
7250sc1_http_req_rate
7251sc2_http_req_rate
7252 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7253 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7254 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7255 src_http_req_rate.
7256
7257sc1_inc_gpc0
7258sc2_inc_gpc0
7259 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7260 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7261 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7262 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7263 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7264 when a first ACL was verified :
7265
7266 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7267 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7268 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7269
7270sc1_kbytes_in
7271sc2_kbytes_in
7272 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7273 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7274 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7275 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7276
7277sc1_kbytes_out
7278sc2_kbytes_out
7279 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7280 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7281 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7282 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7283
7284sc1_sess_cnt
7285sc2_sess_cnt
7286 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7287 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7288 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7289 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7290 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7291 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7292
7293sc1_sess_rate
7294sc2_sess_rate
7295 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7296 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7297 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7298 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7299 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7300 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007302so_id <integer>
7303 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7304
7305src <ip_address>
7306 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7307 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7308 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7309
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007310src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7311src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7312 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7313 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7314 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007315 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007316
7317src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7318src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7319 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7320 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7321 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007322 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007323
7324src_conn_cnt <integer>
7325src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7326 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7327 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7328 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007329 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007330
7331src_conn_cur <integer>
7332src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7333 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7334 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7335 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007336 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007337
7338src_conn_rate <integer>
7339src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7340 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7341 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7342 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007343 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007344
7345src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7346src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7347 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7348 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7349 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007350 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007351
7352src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7353src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7354 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7355 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7356 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007357 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007358
7359src_http_err_rate <integer>
7360src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7361 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7362 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7363 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7364 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007366
7367src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7368src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7369 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7370 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7371 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007372 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007373
7374src_http_req_rate <integer>
7375src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7376 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7377 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7378 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7379 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007380 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007381
7382src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7383src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7384 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7385 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7386 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7387 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7388 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7389 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7390
7391 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7392 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007393 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007394
7395src_kbytes_in <integer>
7396src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7397 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7398 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7399 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7400 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007401 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007402
7403src_kbytes_out <integer>
7404src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7405 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7406 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7407 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7408 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007409 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007410
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007411src_port <integer>
7412 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007413
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007414src_sess_cnt <integer>
7415src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7416 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7417 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7418 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7419 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007420 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007421
7422src_sess_rate <integer>
7423src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7424 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7425 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7426 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7427 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007428 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007429
7430src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7431src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007432 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007433 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7434 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007435 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7436 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7437 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007438 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007439
7440 Example :
7441 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7442 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7443 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7444 listen ssh
7445 bind :22
7446 mode tcp
7447 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007448 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007449 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7450 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7451
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007452srv_id <integer>
7453 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7454
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007455srv_is_up(<server>)
7456srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7457 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7458 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7459 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7460 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7461 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7462 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7463 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7464 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7465
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007466table_avl <integer>
7467table_avl(table) <integer>
7468 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7469 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7470
7471table_cnt <integer>
7472table_cnt(table) <integer>
7473 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7474 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7475 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020074787.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7479---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007480
7481A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7482during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007483through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7484keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007485
7486req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007487 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007488 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7489 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7490 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7491 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7492 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7493 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7494
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007495req_proto_http
7496 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7497 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007498 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007499 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7500 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7501
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007502req_rdp_cookie <string>
7503req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7504 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7505 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7506 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7507 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7508 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7509 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7510 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7511 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7512
7513req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7514req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7515 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7516 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7517 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7518 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7519 cookies.
7520
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007521req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7522 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7523 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7524 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7525 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7526 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7527 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7528 with TCP request content inspection.
7529
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007530req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7531 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7532 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7533 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7534 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7535
7536rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7537 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7538 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7539 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7540 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7541
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007542wait_end
7543 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7544 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7545 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7546 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7547 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7548 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7549 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7550 inspection.
7551
7552 Examples :
7553 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7554 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7555 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7556
7557 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7558 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7559 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7560 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7561 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7562 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7563 tcp-request content reject
7564
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075667.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7567--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007568
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007569A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007570application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7571read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7572than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7573
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007574hdr <string>
7575hdr(header) <string>
7576 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7577 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7578 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7579 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7580 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7581
7582 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7583 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7584 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7585
7586 hdr(Connection) -i close
7587
7588hdr_beg <string>
7589hdr_beg(header) <string>
7590 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7591 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7592 response headers sent by the server.
7593
7594hdr_cnt <integer>
7595hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7596 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7597 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7598 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7599 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7600 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7601 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7602 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7603
7604hdr_dir <string>
7605hdr_dir(header) <string>
7606 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7607 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7608 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7609 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7610 headers sent by the server.
7611
7612hdr_dom <string>
7613hdr_dom(header) <string>
7614 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7615 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7616 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7617 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7618 server.
7619
7620hdr_end <string>
7621hdr_end(header) <string>
7622 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7623 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7624 response headers sent by the server.
7625
7626hdr_ip <ip_address>
7627hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7628 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7629 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7630 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7631 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7632
7633hdr_reg <regex>
7634hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7635 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7636 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7637 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7638 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7639 response headers sent by the server.
7640
7641hdr_sub <string>
7642hdr_sub(header) <string>
7643 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7644 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7645 response headers sent by the server.
7646
7647hdr_val <integer>
7648hdr_val(header) <integer>
7649 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7650 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7651 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7652 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7653
7654http_auth(userlist)
7655http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7656 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7657 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7658 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7659 of specified groups.
7660
7661 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7662
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007663http_req_first
7664 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7665 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7666 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7667 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7668
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007669method <string>
7670 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7671 already check for most common methods.
7672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007673path <string>
7674 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7675 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7676 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7677
7678path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007679 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7680 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007682path_dir <string>
7683 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7684 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7685 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7686 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7687
7688path_dom <string>
7689 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7690 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7691 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7692
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007693path_end <string>
7694 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7695 control file name extension.
7696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007697path_reg <regex>
7698 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7699 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7700 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7701
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007702path_sub <string>
7703 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7704 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7705 "path_dir".
7706
7707req_ver <string>
7708 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7709 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7710
7711status <integer>
7712 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7713 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7714 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007716url <string>
7717 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7718 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7719
7720url_beg <string>
7721 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7722 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007724url_dir <string>
7725 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7726 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7727 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7728 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7729
7730url_dom <string>
7731 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7732 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7733 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7734
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007735url_end <string>
7736 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7737 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007738
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007739url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007740 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7741 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007742 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007743
7744url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007745 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7746 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007747 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007748 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007750url_reg <regex>
7751 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7752 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7753 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007754
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007755url_sub <string>
7756 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7757 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007758
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077607.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7761---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007763Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7764every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007765order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007767ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7768---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007769FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007770HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007771HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7772HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007773HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7774HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7775HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7776HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7777LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007778METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7779METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7780METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7781METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7782METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7783METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007784RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007785REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007786TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007787WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7788---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007789
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077917.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7792----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007794Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7795combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007797 - AND (implicit)
7798 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7799 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007801A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007803 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007805Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7806indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007808For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7809"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7810requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7811is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007813 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7814 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7815 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7816 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007818To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7819and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007821 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7822 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7823 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7824 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007826 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7827 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7828 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7829 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007830
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007831It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7832expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7833be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7834the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7835
7836 The following rule :
7837
7838 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7839 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7840
7841 Can also be written that way :
7842
7843 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7844
7845It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7846to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7847simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7848sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7849good use is the following :
7850
7851 With named ACLs :
7852
7853 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7854 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7855 monitor fail if site_dead
7856
7857 With anonymous ACLs :
7858
7859 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007861See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007862
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007863
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010078647.8. Pattern extraction
7865-----------------------
7866
7867The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7868response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7869for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7870
7871All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7872"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7873begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7874arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7875much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7876equivalent used in ACLs.
7877
7878The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7879
7880 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007881 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7882 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7883 according to RFC 4291.
7884
7885 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
7886 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007887
7888 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7889 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7890 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007891 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7892 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7893 according to RFC 4291.
7894
7895 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
7896 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7897 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007898 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007899
7900 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7901 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7902 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7903 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7904 type integer and only works with such tables.
7905
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007906 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7907 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7908 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7909 x-forwarded-for header.
7910
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007911 payload(offset,length)
7912 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7913 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7914 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7915 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007916
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007917 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7918 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7919 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7920 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7921 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7922 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7923 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7924 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7925 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7926
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007927 url_param(name)
7928 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007929 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007930 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
7931 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
7932 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
7933
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007934 rdp_cookie(name)
7935 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
7936 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
7937 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
7938 done if there is no msts cookie present.
7939
7940 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
7941 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
7942 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
7943 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
7944 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
7945 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
7946 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
7947
7948 Example :
7949 listen tse-farm
7950 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
7951 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7952 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7953 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7954 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7955 persist rdp-cookie
7956 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
7957 # This is only useful makes sense if
7958 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
7959 stick-table type string size 204800
7960 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
7961 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7962 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
7963
7964 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
7965 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
7966
7967
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007968The currently available list of transformations include :
7969
7970 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7971 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7972 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7973
7974 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7975 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7976 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7977
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007978 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7979 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7980 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7981 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7982 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7983
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079858. Logging
7986----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007987
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007988One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7989provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7990very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7991provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7992state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007993to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007994headers.
7995
7996In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7997about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7998send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7999
8000 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8001 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8002 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8003 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8004 at the termination.
8005
8006The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8007allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8008as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8009while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8010real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8011delay.
8012
8013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080148.1. Log levels
8015---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008016
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008017TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008018source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008019HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8020in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8021track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8022syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8023about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008024
8025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080268.2. Log formats
8027----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008028
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008029HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008030and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8031slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8032options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008033
8034 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8035 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8036 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8037 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8038 extents.
8039
8040 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8041 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8042 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8043 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8044 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8045
8046 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8047 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8048 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8049 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8050 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8051
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008052 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8053 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8054 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8055 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8056
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008057Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8058specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8059field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8060servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8061always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8062identifier.
8063
8064Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8065 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8066 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8067 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8068 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8069
8070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080718.2.1. Default log format
8072-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008073
8074This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8075as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8076format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8077
8078 Example :
8079 listen www
8080 mode http
8081 log global
8082 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8083
8084 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8085 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8086 (www/HTTP)
8087
8088 Field Format Extract from the example above
8089 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8090 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8091 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8092 4 'to' to
8093 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8094 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8095
8096Detailed fields description :
8097 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8098 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8099 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8100 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8101 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8102 and processed the connection.
8103 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8104
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008105In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8106"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8107connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008109It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8110will eventually disappear.
8111
8112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081138.2.2. TCP log format
8114---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008115
8116The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8117is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8118information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8119counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8120emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8121environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8122the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8123sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008124specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8125not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8126fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8127marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008128
8129 Example :
8130 frontend fnt
8131 mode tcp
8132 option tcplog
8133 log global
8134 default_backend bck
8135
8136 backend bck
8137 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8138
8139 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8140 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8141 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8142
8143 Field Format Extract from the example above
8144 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8145 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8146 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8147 4 frontend_name fnt
8148 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8149 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8150 7 bytes_read* 212
8151 8 termination_state --
8152 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8153 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8154
8155Detailed fields description :
8156 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008157 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8158 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8159 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8160 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8161 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008162
8163 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008164 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8165 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8166 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008167
8168 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8169 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8170 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8171 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8172
8173 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8174 and processed the connection.
8175
8176 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8177 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8178 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8179 applications.
8180
8181 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8182 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8183 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8184 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8185 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8186
8187 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8188 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8189 See "Timers" below for more details.
8190
8191 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8192 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8193 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8194 "Timers" below for more details.
8195
8196 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8197 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8198 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8199 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8200 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8201 details.
8202
8203 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8204 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8205 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8206 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8207 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8208
8209 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8210 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8211 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8212 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8213 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8214 for more details.
8215
8216 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8217 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8218 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8219 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8220 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008221 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008222
8223 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8224 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8225 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8226 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8227 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8228 caused by a denial of service attack.
8229
8230 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8231 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8232 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8233 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8234 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8235 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8236 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8237 denial of service attack.
8238
8239 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8240 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8241 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8242 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8243 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8244 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8245 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8246 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8247 be processed than on other servers.
8248
8249 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8250 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8251 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8252 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8253 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8254 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8255 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8256 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8257 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8258 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8259 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8260 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8261 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8262
8263 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8264 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8265 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8266 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8267 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8268 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8269 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8270 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8271
8272 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8273 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8274 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8275 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8276 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8277 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8278 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8279 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8280 occurs.
8281
8282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082838.2.3. HTTP log format
8284----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008285
8286The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8287is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8288the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8289are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8290emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8291generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8292"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8293which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008294frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8295is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008296
8297Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8298slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8299with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8300
8301 Example :
8302 frontend http-in
8303 mode http
8304 option httplog
8305 log global
8306 default_backend bck
8307
8308 backend static
8309 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8310
8311 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8312 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8313 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008314 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008315
8316 Field Format Extract from the example above
8317 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8318 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8319 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8320 4 frontend_name http-in
8321 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8322 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8323 7 status_code 200
8324 8 bytes_read* 2750
8325 9 captured_request_cookie -
8326 10 captured_response_cookie -
8327 11 termination_state ----
8328 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8329 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8330 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8331 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8332 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008334
8335Detailed fields description :
8336 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008337 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8338 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8339 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8340 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8341 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008342
8343 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008344 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8345 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8346 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008347
8348 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8349 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8350 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8351 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8352 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8353
8354 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8355 and processed the connection.
8356
8357 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8358 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8359 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8360
8361 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8362 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8363 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8364 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8365 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8366 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8367
8368 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8369 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8370 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8371 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8372 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8373 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8374
8375 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8376 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8377 See "Timers" below for more details.
8378
8379 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8380 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8381 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8382 below for more details.
8383
8384 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8385 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8386 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8387 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8388 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8389 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8390 for more details.
8391
8392 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8393 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8394 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8395 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8396 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8397 details.
8398
8399 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8400 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8401 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8402
8403 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8404 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8405 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8406 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8407 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8408 overflowing.
8409
8410 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8411 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8412 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8413 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8414 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8415 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8416 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8417 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8418
8419 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8420 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8421 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8422 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8423 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8424 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8425 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8426 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8427
8428 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8429 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8430 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8431 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8432 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8433 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8434 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8435
8436 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8437 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8438 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8439 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8440 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008441 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008442 system.
8443
8444 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8445 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8446 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8447 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8448 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8449 caused by a denial of service attack.
8450
8451 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8452 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8453 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8454 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8455 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8456 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8457 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8458 denial of service attack.
8459
8460 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8461 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8462 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8463 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8464 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8465 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8466 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8467 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8468 processed than on other servers.
8469
8470 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8471 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8472 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8473 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8474 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8475 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8476 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8477 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8478 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8479 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8480 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8481 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8482 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8483
8484 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8485 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8486 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8487 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8488 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8489 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8490 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8491 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8492
8493 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8494 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8495 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8496 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8497 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8498 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8499 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8500 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8501 occurs.
8502
8503 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8504 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8505 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8506 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8507 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8508 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8509 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8510 cookies" below for more details.
8511
8512 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8513 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8514 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8515 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8516 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8517 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8518 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8519 and cookies" below for more details.
8520
8521 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8522 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8523 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8524 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8525 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8526 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8527 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8528 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8529
8530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085318.3. Advanced logging options
8532-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008533
8534Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8535just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8536options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8537for more information about their usage.
8538
8539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085408.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8541------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008542
8543It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8544haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8545commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8546monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8547ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8548
8549 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8550 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8551 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8552 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8553
8554 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8555 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8556 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8557 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8558 such as other load-balancers.
8559
8560 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8561 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8562 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8563
8564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085658.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8566----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008567
8568The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8569what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8570or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8571"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8572just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8573log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8574after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8575is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8576with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8577with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8578
8579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085808.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8581------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008582
8583Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8584for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8585"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8586retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8587raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8588a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8589file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8590you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8591"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8592
8593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8595--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008596
8597Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8598multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8599them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8600"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8601logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8602error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8603and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8604too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8605useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8606alternative.
8607
8608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086098.4. Timing events
8610------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008611
8612Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8613reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8614the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8615frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8616mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8617
8618 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8619 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8620 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8621 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8622 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8623
8624 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8625 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8626 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8627 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8628 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8629
8630 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8631 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8632 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8633 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8634 connection never established.
8635
8636 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8637 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8638 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8639 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8640 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8641 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8642 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8643 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8644 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8645 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8646 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8647
8648 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8649 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8650 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8651 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8652 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8653
8654 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8655
8656 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8657 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8658 negative.
8659
8660These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8661protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8662that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008663due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008664close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8665session has been aborted on timeout.
8666
8667Most common cases :
8668
8669 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8670 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8671 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8672 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8673 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8674 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8675 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8676 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8677 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008678 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8679 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8680 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008681
8682 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8683 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8684 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8685 of ms on remote networks.
8686
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008687 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8688 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8689 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008690
8691 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8692 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8693 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8694 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8695 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8696 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8697 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8698 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8699 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8700 to the server until another one is released.
8701
8702Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8703
8704 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8705 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8706 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8707
8708 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8709 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8710 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8711
8712 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8713 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8714 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8715 flags.
8716
8717 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8718 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8719 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8720 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8721 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8722 the client connection was maintained open.
8723
8724 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8725 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8726 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8727 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8728
8729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087308.5. Session state at disconnection
8731-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008732
8733TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8734"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
87352-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8736each of which has a special meaning :
8737
8738 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8739 session to terminate :
8740
8741 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8742
8743 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8744 server explicitly refused it.
8745
8746 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8747 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8748 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8749 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8750 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8751 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8752
8753 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8754 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8755 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8756 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8757 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8758
8759 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8760 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8761 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8762 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8763 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8764
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09008765 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
8766 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
8767
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008768 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8769 send or receive data.
8770
8771 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8772 send or receive data.
8773
8774 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8775 with nothing left in the buffers.
8776
8777 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8778
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008779 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008780 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8781
8782 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8783 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8784 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8785 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8786 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8787
8788 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8789 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8790
8791 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8792 server (HTTP only).
8793
8794 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8795
8796 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8797 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8798 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8799
8800 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8801 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8802 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8803
8804 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8805
8806 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8807 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8808
8809 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8810 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8811 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8812
8813 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8814 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008815 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8816 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008817
8818 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8819 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8820 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8821 another server.
8822
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008823 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008824 server.
8825
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008826 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8827 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8828 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8829 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8830
8831 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8832 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8833 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8834 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8835
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008836 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8837
8838 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8839 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8840
8841 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8842
8843 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8844 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8845 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8846
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008847 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8848 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8849 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8850 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8851 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8852
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008853 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8854
8855 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8856 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8857
8858 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8859
8860 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8861
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008862The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8863was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008864helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8865starvation, attacks, etc...
8866
8867The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8868alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8869easier finding and understanding.
8870
8871 Flags Reason
8872
8873 -- Normal termination.
8874
8875 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8876 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8877 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8878 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8879
8880 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8881 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8882 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8883 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8884 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8885 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008886
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008887 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8888 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8889 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8890
8891 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8892 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8893 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8894
8895 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8896 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8897 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8898 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8899 the server takes too long to respond.
8900
8901 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8902 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8903 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8904 long a time to respond.
8905
8906 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8907 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8908 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8909 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8910 and the client.
8911
8912 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8913 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8914 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8915 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8916 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8917 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8918
8919 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8920 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008921 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8922 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8923 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8924 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008926 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008927 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8928 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8929 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8930 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8931 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8932
8933 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8934 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8935 503 or 504 here.
8936
8937 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8938 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8939 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8940 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8941 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8942
8943 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8944 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008945 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008946 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8947 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8948
8949 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8950 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8951 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8952 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8953 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8954 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8955 between haproxy and the server.
8956
8957 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8958 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8959 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8960 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8961 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8962 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8963 solution is to fix the application.
8964
8965 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8966 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8967 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8968 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8969 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8970 external attacks.
8971
8972 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8973 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8974 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8975 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8976 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8977
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008978 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
8979 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
8980 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
8981 the client.
8982
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008983 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8984 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8985 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8986 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008987 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
8988 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
8989 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
8990 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
8991 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008992
8993 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8994 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8995 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8996 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8997
8998 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8999 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9000 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9001 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9002
9003 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9004 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9005 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9006 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9007
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009008The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9009persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9010important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9011re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9012
9013 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9014
9015 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9016 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9017 set on a GET request.
9018
9019 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9020 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9021 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9022 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9023
9024 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9025 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9026 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9027
9028 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9029 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9030 already got a cookie.
9031
9032 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9033 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9034 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9035 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9036 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9037
9038 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9039 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9040 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9041
9042 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9043 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9044 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9045
9046 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9047 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9048
9049 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9050 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9051 then advertised in the response.
9052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090548.6. Non-printable characters
9055-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009056
9057In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9058consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9059converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9060prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9061being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9062escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9063is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9064'}' when logging headers.
9065
9066Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9067issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9068containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9069
9070Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9071the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9072performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9073
9074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090758.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9076---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009077
9078Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9079achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009080section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009081cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9082the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9083the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009084locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009085not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9086user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9087a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9088wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9089
9090 Examples :
9091 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9092 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9093
9094 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9095 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9096
9097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090988.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9099---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009100
9101Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9102proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9103the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9104server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9105
9106Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9107response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009108section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009109
9110It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009111time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9112appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009113are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9114and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9115follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9116request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9117in the logs.
9118
9119 Example :
9120 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9121 listen proxy-out
9122 mode http
9123 option httplog
9124 option logasap
9125 log global
9126 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9127
9128 # log the name of the virtual server
9129 capture request header Host len 20
9130
9131 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9132 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9133
9134 # log the beginning of the referrer
9135 capture request header Referer len 20
9136
9137 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9138 capture response header Server len 20
9139
9140 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9141 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9142
9143 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9144 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9145
9146 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9147 capture response header Via len 20
9148
9149 # log the URL location during a redirection
9150 capture response header Location len 20
9151
9152 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9153 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9154 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9155 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9156 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9157
9158 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9159 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9160 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9161 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009162 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009163
9164 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9165 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9166 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9167 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9168 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009169 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009170
9171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091728.9. Examples of logs
9173---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009174
9175These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9176them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9177reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9178
9179 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9180 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9181 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9182
9183 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9184 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9185
9186 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9187 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9188 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9189
9190 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9191 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9192
9193 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9194 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9195 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9196
9197 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009198 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009199 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9200 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9201
9202 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9203 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9204 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9205
9206 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9207 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9208 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9209 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9210 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9211 to return the 502 and not the server.
9212
9213 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009214 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009215
9216 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9217 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9218 Nothing was sent to any server.
9219
9220 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9221 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9222
9223 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9224 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9225 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9226 send a 408 return code to the client.
9227
9228 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9229 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9230
9231 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9232 5 seconds ("c----").
9233
9234 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9235 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009236 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009237
9238 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009239 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009240 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9241 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9242 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9243 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9244 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009245
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092479. Statistics and monitoring
9248----------------------------
9249
9250It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9251mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9252CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9253Unix socket.
9254
9255
92569.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009257---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009258
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009259The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9260page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9261
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009262 0. pxname: proxy name
9263 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9264 for server)
9265 2. qcur: current queued requests
9266 3. qmax: max queued requests
9267 4. scur: current sessions
9268 5. smax: max sessions
9269 6. slim: sessions limit
9270 7. stot: total sessions
9271 8. bin: bytes in
9272 9. bout: bytes out
9273 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009274 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009275 12. ereq: request errors
9276 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009277 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009278 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9279 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009280 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009281 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9282 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9283 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9284 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9285 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9286 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9287 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9288 25. qlimit: queue limit
9289 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9290 27. iid: unique proxy id
9291 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9292 29. throttle: warm up status
9293 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9294 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009295 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009296 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9297 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9298 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009299 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009300 UNK -> unknown
9301 INI -> initializing
9302 SOCKERR -> socket error
9303 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9304 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9305 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9306 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9307 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9308 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9309 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9310 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9311 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9312 disable-on-404
9313 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9314 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9315 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009316 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9317 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009318 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9319 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9320 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9321 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9322 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9323 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009324 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9325 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9326 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9327 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009328 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9329 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009330
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093329.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009333-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009334
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009335The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009336must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9337is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9338a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9339risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9340followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9341given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9342then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9343to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009344
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009345It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9346on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9347own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009348
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009349clear counters
9350 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9351 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9352 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9353 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9354 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9355
9356clear counters all
9357 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9358 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9359 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9360
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009361clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9362 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9363
9364 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9365 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9366 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9367 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9368 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9369 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9370
9371 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9372
9373 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9374 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9375 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9376 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9377 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9378 the ACLs :
9379
9380 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9381 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9382 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9383 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9384 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9385 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9386
9387 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009388 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9389 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009390
9391 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009392 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009393 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009394 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9395 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9396 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9397 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009398
9399 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9400
9401 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009402 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009403 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9404 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009405 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9406 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9407 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009408
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009409disable server <backend>/<server>
9410 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9411 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9412 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9413 during the maintenance.
9414
9415 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9416 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9417
9418 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9419 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9420
9421 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9422 level "admin".
9423
9424enable server <backend>/<server>
9425 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9426 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9427
9428 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9429 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9430
9431 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9432 level "admin".
9433
9434get weight <backend>/<server>
9435 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9436 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9437 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9438 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9439 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9440 dash ('#').
9441
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009442help
9443 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9444 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009445
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009446prompt
9447 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9448 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9449 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9450 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9451 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9452 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9453 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9454 command.
9455
9456quit
9457 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009458
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009459set timeout cli <delay>
9460 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9461 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9462 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9463
9464set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9465 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9466 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9467 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9468 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9469 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9470 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9471 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9472 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9473 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9474 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9475 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9476 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9477 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9478 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9479
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009480show errors [<iid>]
9481 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9482 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009483 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9484 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9485 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009486
9487 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9488 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9489 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9490 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9491 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9492 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9493 are reported too.
9494
9495 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9496 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9497 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9498 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9499 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9500 code.
9501
9502 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9503 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9504 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9505 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9506 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9507 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9508 line.
9509
9510 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009511 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9512 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009513 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9514 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9515
9516 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9517 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9518 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9519 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9520 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9521 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9522 00204+ minal\r\n
9523 00211 \r\n
9524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009525 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009526 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9527 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9528 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9529 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9530 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9531 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009532
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009533show info
9534 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9535
9536show sess
9537 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009538 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9539 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9540
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009541show sess <id>
9542 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9543 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9544 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9545 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9546 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9547 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009548
9549show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9550 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9551 possible to dump only selected items :
9552 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9553 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9554 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9555 for example:
9556 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9557 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9558 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9559
9560 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009561 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9562 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009563 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9564 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9565 Nbproc: 1
9566 Process_num: 1
9567 (...)
9568
9569 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9570 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9571 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9572 (...)
9573 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9574
9575 $
9576
9577 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9578 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9579 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9580 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009581 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009582
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009583show table
9584 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9585 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9586 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9587 entries currently in use.
9588
9589 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009590 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9591 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9592 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009593
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009594show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009595 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9596 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9597 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009598 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
9599
9600 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
9601 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
9602 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
9603 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
9604 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9605
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009606 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9607 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9608 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9609 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9610 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9611 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9612
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009613
9614 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009615 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
9616 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009617
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009618 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009619 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9620 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9621 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9622 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9623 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9624 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009625
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009626 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9627 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9628 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9629 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009630
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009631 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9632 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9633 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9634 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9635 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009636
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009637 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
9638 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9639 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9640 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9641 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
9642
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009643 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9644 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9645 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9646 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9647 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9648
9649 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9650 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9651 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009652 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9653 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009654 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9655 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009657/*
9658 * Local variables:
9659 * fill-column: 79
9660 * End:
9661 */